1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF 2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 3 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 4 5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support, 6 <ian@cygnus.com>. 7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC. 8 <mark@codesourcery.com> 9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data 10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net> 11 12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library. 13 14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify 15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by 16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or 17 (at your option) any later version. 18 19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, 20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of 21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the 22 GNU General Public License for more details. 23 24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License 25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software 26 Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ 27 28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */ 29 30 #include "bfd.h" 31 #include "sysdep.h" 32 #include "libbfd.h" 33 #include "libiberty.h" 34 #include "elf-bfd.h" 35 #include "elfxx-mips.h" 36 #include "elf/mips.h" 37 38 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */ 39 #include "coff/sym.h" 40 #include "coff/symconst.h" 41 #include "coff/ecoff.h" 42 #include "coff/mips.h" 43 44 #include "hashtab.h" 45 46 /* This structure is used to hold .got entries while estimating got 47 sizes. */ 48 struct mips_got_entry 49 { 50 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */ 51 bfd *abfd; 52 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if 53 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */ 54 long symndx; 55 union 56 { 57 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */ 58 bfd_vma address; 59 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation 60 that should be added to the symbol value. */ 61 bfd_vma addend; 62 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry 63 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if 64 h->forced_local). */ 65 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 66 } d; 67 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry 68 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol 69 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */ 70 long gotidx; 71 }; 72 73 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */ 74 75 struct mips_got_info 76 { 77 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic 78 symbol table. */ 79 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym; 80 /* The number of global .got entries. */ 81 unsigned int global_gotno; 82 /* The number of local .got entries. */ 83 unsigned int local_gotno; 84 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */ 85 unsigned int assigned_gotno; 86 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */ 87 struct htab *got_entries; 88 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL 89 unless multi-got was necessary. */ 90 struct htab *bfd2got; 91 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most 92 of the time, it points to the previous got). */ 93 struct mips_got_info *next; 94 }; 95 96 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */ 97 98 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash { 99 bfd *bfd; 100 struct mips_got_info *g; 101 }; 102 103 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to 104 create and merge bfd's gots. */ 105 106 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg 107 { 108 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */ 109 htab_t bfd2got; 110 /* The output bfd. */ 111 bfd *obfd; 112 /* The link information. */ 113 struct bfd_link_info *info; 114 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get 115 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and 116 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */ 117 struct mips_got_info *primary; 118 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's 119 gots. */ 120 struct mips_got_info *current; 121 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a 122 16-bit offset. */ 123 unsigned int max_count; 124 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */ 125 unsigned int primary_count; 126 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */ 127 unsigned int current_count; 128 }; 129 130 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */ 131 132 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg 133 { 134 struct mips_got_info *g; 135 int value; 136 unsigned int needed_relocs; 137 struct bfd_link_info *info; 138 }; 139 140 struct _mips_elf_section_data 141 { 142 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf; 143 union 144 { 145 struct mips_got_info *got_info; 146 bfd_byte *tdata; 147 } u; 148 }; 149 150 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \ 151 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec)) 152 153 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting 154 the dynamic symbols. */ 155 156 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data 157 { 158 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table 159 index. */ 160 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low; 161 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol 162 with a GOT entry. */ 163 long min_got_dynindx; 164 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol 165 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol 166 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */ 167 long max_unref_got_dynindx; 168 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a 169 symbol without a GOT entry. */ 170 long max_non_got_dynindx; 171 }; 172 173 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in 174 the global hash table. */ 175 176 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry 177 { 178 struct elf_link_hash_entry root; 179 180 /* External symbol information. */ 181 EXTR esym; 182 183 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against 184 this symbol. */ 185 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs; 186 187 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against 188 a readonly section. */ 189 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc; 190 191 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations 192 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but 193 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition", 194 p. 4-20. */ 195 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub; 196 197 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this 198 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */ 199 asection *fn_stub; 200 201 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears 202 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */ 203 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub; 204 205 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this 206 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */ 207 asection *call_stub; 208 209 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function 210 being called returns a floating point value. */ 211 asection *call_fp_stub; 212 213 /* Are we forced local? .*/ 214 bfd_boolean forced_local; 215 }; 216 217 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */ 218 219 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table 220 { 221 struct elf_link_hash_table root; 222 #if 0 223 /* We no longer use this. */ 224 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */ 225 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES]; 226 #endif 227 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */ 228 bfd_size_type procedure_count; 229 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */ 230 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size; 231 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic 232 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */ 233 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head; 234 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */ 235 bfd_vma rld_value; 236 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */ 237 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen; 238 }; 239 240 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */ 241 242 struct extsym_info 243 { 244 bfd *abfd; 245 struct bfd_link_info *info; 246 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug; 247 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap; 248 bfd_boolean failed; 249 }; 250 251 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */ 252 253 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] = 254 { 255 "_procedure_table", 256 "_procedure_string_table", 257 "_procedure_table_size", 258 NULL 259 }; 260 261 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on 262 IRIX5. */ 263 264 typedef struct 265 { 266 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */ 267 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */ 268 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */ 269 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */ 270 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */ 271 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */ 272 } Elf32_compact_rel; 273 274 typedef struct 275 { 276 bfd_byte id1[4]; 277 bfd_byte num[4]; 278 bfd_byte id2[4]; 279 bfd_byte offset[4]; 280 bfd_byte reserved0[4]; 281 bfd_byte reserved1[4]; 282 } Elf32_External_compact_rel; 283 284 typedef struct 285 { 286 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */ 287 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */ 288 unsigned int dist2to : 8; 289 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */ 290 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */ 291 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */ 292 } Elf32_crinfo; 293 294 typedef struct 295 { 296 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */ 297 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */ 298 unsigned int dist2to : 8; 299 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */ 300 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */ 301 } Elf32_crinfo2; 302 303 typedef struct 304 { 305 bfd_byte info[4]; 306 bfd_byte konst[4]; 307 bfd_byte vaddr[4]; 308 } Elf32_External_crinfo; 309 310 typedef struct 311 { 312 bfd_byte info[4]; 313 bfd_byte konst[4]; 314 } Elf32_External_crinfo2; 315 316 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */ 317 318 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1) 319 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31) 320 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf) 321 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27) 322 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff) 323 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19) 324 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff) 325 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0) 326 327 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words) 328 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr 329 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */ 330 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1 331 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0 332 333 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST 334 has different meaning for each type: 335 336 (type) (konst) 337 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data 338 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX) 339 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr 340 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump 341 */ 342 343 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa 344 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb 345 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc 346 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd 347 348 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format)) 349 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type)) 350 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v)) 351 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2) 352 353 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the 354 loader for use by the static exception system. */ 355 356 typedef struct runtime_pdr { 357 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */ 358 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */ 359 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */ 360 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */ 361 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */ 362 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */ 363 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */ 364 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */ 365 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */ 366 long reserved; 367 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */ 368 } RPDR, *pRPDR; 369 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR) 370 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0) 371 372 static struct bfd_hash_entry *mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc 373 (struct bfd_hash_entry *, struct bfd_hash_table *, const char *); 374 static void ecoff_swap_rpdr_out 375 (bfd *, const RPDR *, struct rpdr_ext *); 376 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_procedure_table 377 (void *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *, 378 struct ecoff_debug_info *); 379 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs 380 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *); 381 static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in 382 (bfd *, const Elf32_External_gptab *, Elf32_gptab *); 383 static void bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out 384 (bfd *, const Elf32_gptab *, Elf32_External_gptab *); 385 static void bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out 386 (bfd *, const Elf32_compact_rel *, Elf32_External_compact_rel *); 387 static void bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out 388 (bfd *, const Elf32_crinfo *, Elf32_External_crinfo *); 389 static int sort_dynamic_relocs 390 (const void *, const void *); 391 static int sort_dynamic_relocs_64 392 (const void *, const void *); 393 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_output_extsym 394 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *); 395 static int gptab_compare 396 (const void *, const void *); 397 static asection *mips_elf_rel_dyn_section 398 (bfd *, bfd_boolean); 399 static asection *mips_elf_got_section 400 (bfd *, bfd_boolean); 401 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_info 402 (bfd *, asection **); 403 static long mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index 404 (bfd *abfd); 405 static bfd_vma mips_elf_local_got_index 406 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma); 407 static bfd_vma mips_elf_global_got_index 408 (bfd *, bfd *, struct elf_link_hash_entry *); 409 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_page 410 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma *); 411 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got16_entry 412 (bfd *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_vma, bfd_boolean); 413 static bfd_vma mips_elf_got_offset_from_index 414 (bfd *, bfd *, bfd *, bfd_vma); 415 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry 416 (bfd *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *, bfd_vma); 417 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table 418 (struct bfd_link_info *, unsigned long); 419 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f 420 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *); 421 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol 422 (bfd *, long, bfd_vma, struct mips_got_info *); 423 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol 424 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, 425 struct mips_got_info *); 426 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *mips_elf_next_relocation 427 (bfd *, unsigned int, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *); 428 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_local_relocation_p 429 (bfd *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, asection **, bfd_boolean); 430 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_overflow_p 431 (bfd_vma, int); 432 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high 433 (bfd_vma); 434 static bfd_vma mips_elf_higher 435 (bfd_vma); 436 static bfd_vma mips_elf_highest 437 (bfd_vma); 438 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section 439 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *); 440 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_got_section 441 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_boolean); 442 static bfd_reloc_status_type mips_elf_calculate_relocation 443 (bfd *, bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, 444 const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma, reloc_howto_type *, 445 Elf_Internal_Sym *, asection **, bfd_vma *, const char **, 446 bfd_boolean *, bfd_boolean); 447 static bfd_vma mips_elf_obtain_contents 448 (reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, bfd_byte *); 449 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_perform_relocation 450 (struct bfd_link_info *, reloc_howto_type *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, 451 bfd_vma, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_boolean); 452 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_stub_section_p 453 (bfd *, asection *); 454 static void mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations 455 (bfd *, unsigned int); 456 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation 457 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *, 458 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma, 459 bfd_vma *, asection *); 460 static void mips_set_isa_flags 461 (bfd *); 462 static INLINE char *elf_mips_abi_name 463 (bfd *); 464 static void mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol 465 (bfd *, const char *, Elf_Internal_Sym *); 466 static bfd_boolean mips_mach_extends_p 467 (unsigned long, unsigned long); 468 static bfd_boolean mips_32bit_flags_p 469 (flagword); 470 static INLINE hashval_t mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma 471 (bfd_vma); 472 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash 473 (const void *); 474 static int mips_elf_got_entry_eq 475 (const void *, const void *); 476 477 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_multi_got 478 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, struct mips_got_info *, 479 asection *, bfd_size_type); 480 static hashval_t mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash 481 (const void *); 482 static int mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq 483 (const void *, const void *); 484 static hashval_t mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash 485 (const void *); 486 static int mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq 487 (const void *, const void *); 488 static int mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd 489 (void **, void *); 490 static int mips_elf_merge_gots 491 (void **, void *); 492 static int mips_elf_set_global_got_offset 493 (void **, void *); 494 static int mips_elf_set_no_stub 495 (void **, void *); 496 static int mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry 497 (void **, void *); 498 static void mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries 499 (struct mips_got_info *); 500 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp 501 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *); 502 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd 503 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *); 504 505 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */ 506 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd; 507 508 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */ 509 510 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \ 511 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0) 512 513 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */ 514 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \ 515 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64) 516 517 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */ 518 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd)) 519 520 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */ 521 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \ 522 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd)) 523 524 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */ 525 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \ 526 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none) 527 528 /* The name of the options section. */ 529 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \ 530 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options") 531 532 /* The name of the stub section. */ 533 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs" 534 535 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */ 536 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \ 537 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel) 538 539 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */ 540 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \ 541 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn) 542 543 /* The size of a GOT entry. */ 544 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \ 545 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8) 546 547 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */ 548 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \ 549 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym) 550 551 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */ 552 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \ 553 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align) 554 555 /* Get word-sized data. */ 556 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \ 557 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr)) 558 559 /* Put out word-sized data. */ 560 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \ 561 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \ 562 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \ 563 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr)) 564 565 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */ 566 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \ 567 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val) 568 569 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \ 570 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela)) 571 572 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL 573 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are 574 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and 575 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is 576 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external 577 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if 578 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first 579 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second 580 section, that is RELA. */ 581 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \ 582 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \ 583 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \ 584 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \ 585 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \ 586 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \ 587 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))) 588 589 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value 590 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */ 591 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1) 592 593 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */ 594 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (2) 595 596 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */ 597 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) (0x7ff0) 598 599 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit 600 offsets from $gp. */ 601 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(abfd) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) + 0x7fff) 602 603 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */ 604 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \ 605 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \ 606 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \ 607 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */ 608 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \ 609 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \ 610 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \ 611 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */ 612 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */ 613 #define STUB_LI16(abfd) \ 614 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \ 615 ? 0x64180000 /* daddiu t8,zero,0 */ \ 616 : 0x24180000)) /* addiu t8,zero,0 */ 617 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE (16) 618 619 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp 620 section. */ 621 622 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \ 623 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \ 624 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \ 625 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1") 626 627 #ifdef BFD64 628 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \ 629 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)) 630 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \ 631 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i)) 632 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \ 633 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i)) 634 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \ 635 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t)) 636 #else 637 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos) 638 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \ 639 (ELF32_R_SYM (i)) 640 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \ 641 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i)) 642 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \ 643 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t)) 644 #endif 645 646 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle 647 floating point arguments. 648 649 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that 650 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and 651 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the 652 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit 653 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to 654 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because 655 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub, 656 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function. 657 658 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs 659 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp 660 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function, 661 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected 662 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the 663 stub should be discarded. 664 665 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs 666 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs 667 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while 668 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs 669 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not 670 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because 671 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both 672 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.) 673 674 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically. 675 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation 676 information will indicate which symbol the section is for. 677 678 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */ 679 680 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn." 681 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call." 682 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp." 683 684 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */ 685 686 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \ 687 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \ 688 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \ 689 (copy), (follow))) 690 691 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */ 692 693 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \ 694 (elf_link_hash_traverse \ 695 (&(table)->root, \ 696 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \ 697 (info))) 698 699 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */ 700 701 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \ 702 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) 703 704 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */ 705 706 static struct bfd_hash_entry * 707 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry, 708 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string) 709 { 710 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret = 711 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry; 712 713 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a 714 subclass. */ 715 if (ret == NULL) 716 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)); 717 if (ret == NULL) 718 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret; 719 720 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */ 721 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 722 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret, 723 table, string)); 724 if (ret != NULL) 725 { 726 /* Set local fields. */ 727 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR)); 728 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has 729 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */ 730 ret->esym.ifd = -2; 731 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0; 732 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE; 733 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE; 734 ret->fn_stub = NULL; 735 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE; 736 ret->call_stub = NULL; 737 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL; 738 ret->forced_local = FALSE; 739 } 740 741 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret; 742 } 743 744 bfd_boolean 745 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec) 746 { 747 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata; 748 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata); 749 750 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 751 if (sdata == NULL) 752 return FALSE; 753 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata; 754 755 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec); 756 } 757 758 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a 759 ecoff_debug_info structure. */ 760 761 bfd_boolean 762 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section, 763 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug) 764 { 765 HDRR *symhdr; 766 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap; 767 char *ext_hdr; 768 769 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap; 770 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug)); 771 772 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size); 773 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0) 774 goto error_return; 775 776 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0, 777 swap->external_hdr_size)) 778 goto error_return; 779 780 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header; 781 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr); 782 783 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to 784 read. */ 785 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \ 786 if (symhdr->count == 0) \ 787 debug->ptr = NULL; \ 788 else \ 789 { \ 790 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \ 791 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \ 792 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \ 793 goto error_return; \ 794 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \ 795 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \ 796 goto error_return; \ 797 } 798 799 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *); 800 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *); 801 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *); 802 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *); 803 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *); 804 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext), 805 union aux_ext *); 806 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *); 807 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *); 808 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *); 809 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *); 810 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *); 811 #undef READ 812 813 debug->fdr = NULL; 814 debug->adjust = NULL; 815 816 return TRUE; 817 818 error_return: 819 if (ext_hdr != NULL) 820 free (ext_hdr); 821 if (debug->line != NULL) 822 free (debug->line); 823 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL) 824 free (debug->external_dnr); 825 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL) 826 free (debug->external_pdr); 827 if (debug->external_sym != NULL) 828 free (debug->external_sym); 829 if (debug->external_opt != NULL) 830 free (debug->external_opt); 831 if (debug->external_aux != NULL) 832 free (debug->external_aux); 833 if (debug->ss != NULL) 834 free (debug->ss); 835 if (debug->ssext != NULL) 836 free (debug->ssext); 837 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL) 838 free (debug->external_fdr); 839 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL) 840 free (debug->external_rfd); 841 if (debug->external_ext != NULL) 842 free (debug->external_ext); 843 return FALSE; 844 } 845 846 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */ 847 848 static void 849 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex) 850 { 851 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr); 852 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask); 853 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset); 854 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask); 855 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset); 856 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset); 857 858 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg); 859 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg); 860 861 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss); 862 #if 0 /* FIXME */ 863 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->exception_info, ex->p_exception_info); 864 #endif 865 } 866 867 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */ 868 869 static bfd_boolean 870 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd, 871 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s, 872 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug) 873 { 874 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap; 875 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header; 876 RPDR *rpdr, *rp; 877 struct rpdr_ext *erp; 878 void *rtproc; 879 struct pdr_ext *epdr; 880 struct sym_ext *esym; 881 char *ss, **sv; 882 char *str; 883 bfd_size_type size; 884 bfd_size_type count; 885 unsigned long sindex; 886 unsigned long i; 887 PDR pdr; 888 SYMR sym; 889 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)"); 890 891 epdr = NULL; 892 rpdr = NULL; 893 esym = NULL; 894 ss = NULL; 895 sv = NULL; 896 897 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap; 898 899 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1; 900 count = hdr->ipdMax; 901 if (count > 0) 902 { 903 size = swap->external_pdr_size; 904 905 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count); 906 if (epdr == NULL) 907 goto error_return; 908 909 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr)) 910 goto error_return; 911 912 size = sizeof (RPDR); 913 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count); 914 if (rpdr == NULL) 915 goto error_return; 916 917 size = sizeof (char *); 918 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count); 919 if (sv == NULL) 920 goto error_return; 921 922 count = hdr->isymMax; 923 size = swap->external_sym_size; 924 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count); 925 if (esym == NULL) 926 goto error_return; 927 928 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym)) 929 goto error_return; 930 931 count = hdr->issMax; 932 ss = bfd_malloc (count); 933 if (ss == NULL) 934 goto error_return; 935 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, ss)) 936 goto error_return; 937 938 count = hdr->ipdMax; 939 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++) 940 { 941 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr); 942 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym); 943 rp->adr = sym.value; 944 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask; 945 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset; 946 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask; 947 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset; 948 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset; 949 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg; 950 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg; 951 rp->irpss = sindex; 952 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss; 953 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1; 954 } 955 } 956 957 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex; 958 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16); 959 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size); 960 if (rtproc == NULL) 961 { 962 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0; 963 goto error_return; 964 } 965 966 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2; 967 968 erp = rtproc; 969 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext)); 970 erp++; 971 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2); 972 strcpy (str, no_name_func); 973 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1; 974 for (i = 0; i < count; i++) 975 { 976 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i); 977 strcpy (str, sv[i]); 978 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1; 979 } 980 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr); 981 982 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */ 983 s->_raw_size = size; 984 s->contents = rtproc; 985 986 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently 987 matters, but someday it might). */ 988 s->link_order_head = NULL; 989 990 if (epdr != NULL) 991 free (epdr); 992 if (rpdr != NULL) 993 free (rpdr); 994 if (esym != NULL) 995 free (esym); 996 if (ss != NULL) 997 free (ss); 998 if (sv != NULL) 999 free (sv); 1000 1001 return TRUE; 1002 1003 error_return: 1004 if (epdr != NULL) 1005 free (epdr); 1006 if (rpdr != NULL) 1007 free (rpdr); 1008 if (esym != NULL) 1009 free (esym); 1010 if (ss != NULL) 1011 free (ss); 1012 if (sv != NULL) 1013 free (sv); 1014 return FALSE; 1015 } 1016 1017 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can 1018 discard them. */ 1019 1020 static bfd_boolean 1021 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, 1022 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1023 { 1024 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 1025 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 1026 1027 if (h->fn_stub != NULL 1028 && ! h->need_fn_stub) 1029 { 1030 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol 1031 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from 1032 being included in the link. */ 1033 h->fn_stub->_raw_size = 0; 1034 h->fn_stub->_cooked_size = 0; 1035 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC; 1036 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0; 1037 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 1038 } 1039 1040 if (h->call_stub != NULL 1041 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16) 1042 { 1043 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so 1044 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size 1045 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */ 1046 h->call_stub->_raw_size = 0; 1047 h->call_stub->_cooked_size = 0; 1048 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC; 1049 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0; 1050 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 1051 } 1052 1053 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL 1054 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16) 1055 { 1056 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so 1057 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size 1058 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */ 1059 h->call_fp_stub->_raw_size = 0; 1060 h->call_fp_stub->_cooked_size = 0; 1061 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC; 1062 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0; 1063 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 1064 } 1065 1066 return TRUE; 1067 } 1068 1069 bfd_reloc_status_type 1070 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol, 1071 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section, 1072 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp) 1073 { 1074 bfd_vma relocation; 1075 bfd_signed_vma val; 1076 bfd_reloc_status_type status; 1077 1078 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section)) 1079 relocation = 0; 1080 else 1081 relocation = symbol->value; 1082 1083 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma; 1084 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset; 1085 1086 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size) 1087 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 1088 1089 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */ 1090 val = reloc_entry->addend; 1091 1092 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16); 1093 1094 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we 1095 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for 1096 an external symbol. */ 1097 if (! relocatable 1098 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0) 1099 val += relocation - gp; 1100 1101 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace) 1102 { 1103 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val, 1104 (bfd_byte *) data 1105 + reloc_entry->address); 1106 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok) 1107 return status; 1108 } 1109 else 1110 reloc_entry->addend = val; 1111 1112 if (relocatable) 1113 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset; 1114 1115 return bfd_reloc_ok; 1116 } 1117 1118 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or 1119 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section 1120 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of 1121 INPUT_SECTION. */ 1122 1123 struct mips_hi16 1124 { 1125 struct mips_hi16 *next; 1126 bfd_byte *data; 1127 asection *input_section; 1128 arelent rel; 1129 }; 1130 1131 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */ 1132 1133 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list; 1134 1135 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only 1136 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering 1137 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later. 1138 1139 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16. 1140 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of 1141 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly 1142 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */ 1143 1144 bfd_reloc_status_type 1145 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry, 1146 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data, 1147 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd, 1148 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1149 { 1150 struct mips_hi16 *n; 1151 1152 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size) 1153 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 1154 1155 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n); 1156 if (n == NULL) 1157 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 1158 1159 n->next = mips_hi16_list; 1160 n->data = data; 1161 n->input_section = input_section; 1162 n->rel = *reloc_entry; 1163 mips_hi16_list = n; 1164 1165 if (output_bfd != NULL) 1166 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset; 1167 1168 return bfd_reloc_ok; 1169 } 1170 1171 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just 1172 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is 1173 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */ 1174 1175 bfd_reloc_status_type 1176 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol, 1177 void *data, asection *input_section, 1178 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message) 1179 { 1180 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0 1181 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)) 1182 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))) 1183 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */ 1184 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data, 1185 input_section, output_bfd, 1186 error_message); 1187 1188 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data, 1189 input_section, output_bfd, error_message); 1190 } 1191 1192 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself 1193 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with 1194 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */ 1195 1196 bfd_reloc_status_type 1197 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol, 1198 void *data, asection *input_section, 1199 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message) 1200 { 1201 bfd_vma vallo; 1202 1203 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size) 1204 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 1205 1206 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address); 1207 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL) 1208 { 1209 bfd_reloc_status_type ret; 1210 struct mips_hi16 *hi; 1211 1212 hi = mips_hi16_list; 1213 1214 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We 1215 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16 1216 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16 1217 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto 1218 has a rightshift of 0. */ 1219 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16) 1220 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE); 1221 1222 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any 1223 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */ 1224 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff; 1225 1226 /* R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16 relocations are relative to the address of the 1227 lo16 relocation, not their own address. If we're calculating the 1228 final value, and hence subtracting the "PC", subtract the offset 1229 of the lo16 relocation from here. */ 1230 if (output_bfd == NULL && hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16) 1231 hi->rel.addend -= reloc_entry->address - hi->rel.address; 1232 1233 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data, 1234 hi->input_section, output_bfd, 1235 error_message); 1236 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok) 1237 return ret; 1238 1239 mips_hi16_list = hi->next; 1240 free (hi); 1241 } 1242 1243 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data, 1244 input_section, output_bfd, 1245 error_message); 1246 } 1247 1248 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the 1249 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in 1250 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */ 1251 1252 bfd_reloc_status_type 1253 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry, 1254 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 1255 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd, 1256 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 1257 { 1258 bfd_signed_vma val; 1259 bfd_reloc_status_type status; 1260 bfd_boolean relocatable; 1261 1262 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL); 1263 1264 if (reloc_entry->address > input_section->_cooked_size) 1265 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 1266 1267 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */ 1268 val = 0; 1269 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0) 1270 { 1271 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a 1272 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's 1273 offset or address. */ 1274 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma; 1275 val += symbol->section->output_offset; 1276 } 1277 1278 if (!relocatable) 1279 { 1280 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value 1281 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */ 1282 val += symbol->value; 1283 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative) 1284 { 1285 val -= input_section->output_section->vma; 1286 val -= input_section->output_offset; 1287 val -= reloc_entry->address; 1288 } 1289 } 1290 1291 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation 1292 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend, 1293 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add 1294 VAL to the relocation field itself. */ 1295 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace) 1296 reloc_entry->addend += val; 1297 else 1298 { 1299 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */ 1300 val += reloc_entry->addend; 1301 1302 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */ 1303 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val, 1304 (bfd_byte *) data 1305 + reloc_entry->address); 1306 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok) 1307 return status; 1308 } 1309 1310 if (relocatable) 1311 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset; 1312 1313 return bfd_reloc_ok; 1314 } 1315 1316 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely 1317 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */ 1318 1319 static void 1320 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex, 1321 Elf32_gptab *in) 1322 { 1323 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value); 1324 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes); 1325 } 1326 1327 static void 1328 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in, 1329 Elf32_External_gptab *ex) 1330 { 1331 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value); 1332 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes); 1333 } 1334 1335 static void 1336 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in, 1337 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex) 1338 { 1339 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1); 1340 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num); 1341 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2); 1342 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset); 1343 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0); 1344 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1); 1345 } 1346 1347 static void 1348 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in, 1349 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex) 1350 { 1351 unsigned long l; 1352 1353 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH) 1354 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH) 1355 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH) 1356 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH)); 1357 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info); 1358 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst); 1359 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr); 1360 } 1361 1362 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These 1363 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of 1364 BFD, so they are globally visible. */ 1365 1366 void 1367 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex, 1368 Elf32_RegInfo *in) 1369 { 1370 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask); 1371 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]); 1372 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]); 1373 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]); 1374 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]); 1375 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value); 1376 } 1377 1378 void 1379 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in, 1380 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex) 1381 { 1382 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask); 1383 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]); 1384 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]); 1385 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]); 1386 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]); 1387 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value); 1388 } 1389 1390 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register 1391 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap 1392 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used 1393 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them 1394 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */ 1395 1396 void 1397 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex, 1398 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in) 1399 { 1400 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask); 1401 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad); 1402 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]); 1403 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]); 1404 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]); 1405 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]); 1406 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value); 1407 } 1408 1409 void 1410 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in, 1411 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex) 1412 { 1413 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask); 1414 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad); 1415 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]); 1416 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]); 1417 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]); 1418 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]); 1419 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value); 1420 } 1421 1422 /* Swap in an options header. */ 1423 1424 void 1425 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex, 1426 Elf_Internal_Options *in) 1427 { 1428 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind); 1429 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size); 1430 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section); 1431 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info); 1432 } 1433 1434 /* Swap out an options header. */ 1435 1436 void 1437 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in, 1438 Elf_External_Options *ex) 1439 { 1440 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind); 1441 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size); 1442 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section); 1443 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info); 1444 } 1445 1446 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation 1447 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */ 1448 1449 static int 1450 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2) 1451 { 1452 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1; 1453 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2; 1454 1455 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1); 1456 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2); 1457 1458 return ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info); 1459 } 1460 1461 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */ 1462 1463 static int 1464 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1, const void *arg2) 1465 { 1466 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3]; 1467 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3]; 1468 1469 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in) 1470 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1); 1471 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in) 1472 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2); 1473 1474 return (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) 1475 - ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info)); 1476 } 1477 1478 1479 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol 1480 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The 1481 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external 1482 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know 1483 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two 1484 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external 1485 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug 1486 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we 1487 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are 1488 required by relocation until we relocate the sections. 1489 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be 1490 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen 1491 when generating a final executable. */ 1492 1493 static bfd_boolean 1494 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data) 1495 { 1496 struct extsym_info *einfo = data; 1497 bfd_boolean strip; 1498 asection *sec, *output_section; 1499 1500 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 1501 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 1502 1503 if (h->root.indx == -2) 1504 strip = FALSE; 1505 else if (((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0 1506 || (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_DYNAMIC) != 0) 1507 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0 1508 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) == 0) 1509 strip = TRUE; 1510 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all 1511 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some 1512 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash, 1513 h->root.root.root.string, 1514 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL)) 1515 strip = TRUE; 1516 else 1517 strip = FALSE; 1518 1519 if (strip) 1520 return TRUE; 1521 1522 if (h->esym.ifd == -2) 1523 { 1524 h->esym.jmptbl = 0; 1525 h->esym.cobol_main = 0; 1526 h->esym.weakext = 0; 1527 h->esym.reserved = 0; 1528 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil; 1529 h->esym.asym.value = 0; 1530 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal; 1531 1532 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined 1533 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak) 1534 { 1535 const char *name; 1536 1537 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some 1538 special symbols. */ 1539 name = h->root.root.root.string; 1540 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0 1541 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0) 1542 { 1543 h->esym.asym.sc = scData; 1544 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel; 1545 h->esym.asym.value = 0; 1546 } 1547 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0) 1548 { 1549 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs; 1550 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel; 1551 h->esym.asym.value = 1552 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count; 1553 } 1554 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd)) 1555 { 1556 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs; 1557 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel; 1558 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd); 1559 } 1560 else 1561 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined; 1562 } 1563 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined 1564 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak) 1565 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs; 1566 else 1567 { 1568 const char *name; 1569 1570 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section; 1571 output_section = sec->output_section; 1572 1573 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from 1574 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */ 1575 if (output_section == NULL) 1576 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined; 1577 else 1578 { 1579 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section); 1580 1581 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0) 1582 h->esym.asym.sc = scText; 1583 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0) 1584 h->esym.asym.sc = scData; 1585 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0) 1586 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData; 1587 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0 1588 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0) 1589 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData; 1590 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0) 1591 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss; 1592 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0) 1593 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss; 1594 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0) 1595 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit; 1596 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0) 1597 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini; 1598 else 1599 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs; 1600 } 1601 } 1602 1603 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0; 1604 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil; 1605 } 1606 1607 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common) 1608 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size; 1609 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 1610 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) 1611 { 1612 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon) 1613 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss; 1614 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon) 1615 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss; 1616 1617 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section; 1618 output_section = sec->output_section; 1619 if (output_section != NULL) 1620 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value 1621 + sec->output_offset 1622 + output_section->vma); 1623 else 1624 h->esym.asym.value = 0; 1625 } 1626 else if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0) 1627 { 1628 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h; 1629 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub; 1630 1631 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect) 1632 { 1633 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link; 1634 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub; 1635 } 1636 1637 if (!no_fn_stub) 1638 { 1639 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */ 1640 h->esym.asym.st = stProc; 1641 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section; 1642 if (sec == NULL) 1643 h->esym.asym.value = 0; 1644 else 1645 { 1646 output_section = sec->output_section; 1647 if (output_section != NULL) 1648 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset 1649 + sec->output_offset 1650 + output_section->vma); 1651 else 1652 h->esym.asym.value = 0; 1653 } 1654 #if 0 /* FIXME? */ 1655 h->esym.ifd = 0; 1656 #endif 1657 } 1658 } 1659 1660 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap, 1661 h->root.root.root.string, 1662 &h->esym)) 1663 { 1664 einfo->failed = TRUE; 1665 return FALSE; 1666 } 1667 1668 return TRUE; 1669 } 1670 1671 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */ 1672 1673 static int 1674 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2) 1675 { 1676 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1; 1677 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2; 1678 1679 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value; 1680 } 1681 1682 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */ 1683 1684 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit 1685 hash number. */ 1686 1687 static INLINE hashval_t 1688 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr) 1689 { 1690 #ifdef BFD64 1691 return addr + (addr >> 32); 1692 #else 1693 return addr; 1694 #endif 1695 } 1696 1697 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so 1698 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate 1699 union members. */ 1700 1701 static hashval_t 1702 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_) 1703 { 1704 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_; 1705 1706 return entry->symndx 1707 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address) 1708 : entry->abfd->id 1709 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend) 1710 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash)); 1711 } 1712 1713 static int 1714 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2) 1715 { 1716 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1; 1717 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2; 1718 1719 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx 1720 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address 1721 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend 1722 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h); 1723 } 1724 1725 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects, 1726 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the 1727 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted 1728 accordingly. */ 1729 1730 static hashval_t 1731 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_) 1732 { 1733 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_; 1734 1735 return entry->symndx 1736 + (! entry->abfd 1737 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address) 1738 : entry->symndx >= 0 1739 ? (entry->abfd->id 1740 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)) 1741 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash); 1742 } 1743 1744 static int 1745 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2) 1746 { 1747 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1; 1748 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2; 1749 1750 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx 1751 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend 1752 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL 1753 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address 1754 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h); 1755 } 1756 1757 /* Returns the dynamic relocation section for DYNOBJ. */ 1758 1759 static asection * 1760 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (bfd *dynobj, bfd_boolean create_p) 1761 { 1762 static const char dname[] = ".rel.dyn"; 1763 asection *sreloc; 1764 1765 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname); 1766 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p) 1767 { 1768 sreloc = bfd_make_section (dynobj, dname); 1769 if (sreloc == NULL 1770 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, sreloc, 1771 (SEC_ALLOC 1772 | SEC_LOAD 1773 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS 1774 | SEC_IN_MEMORY 1775 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED 1776 | SEC_READONLY)) 1777 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc, 1778 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj))) 1779 return NULL; 1780 } 1781 return sreloc; 1782 } 1783 1784 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */ 1785 1786 static asection * 1787 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded) 1788 { 1789 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got"); 1790 if (sgot == NULL 1791 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)) 1792 return NULL; 1793 return sgot; 1794 } 1795 1796 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by 1797 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT 1798 section. */ 1799 1800 static struct mips_got_info * 1801 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp) 1802 { 1803 asection *sgot; 1804 struct mips_got_info *g; 1805 1806 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE); 1807 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL); 1808 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL); 1809 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info; 1810 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 1811 1812 if (sgotp) 1813 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL; 1814 1815 return g; 1816 } 1817 1818 /* Obtain the lowest dynamic index of a symbol that was assigned a 1819 global GOT entry. */ 1820 static long 1821 mips_elf_get_global_gotsym_index (bfd *abfd) 1822 { 1823 asection *sgot; 1824 struct mips_got_info *g; 1825 1826 if (abfd == NULL) 1827 return 0; 1828 1829 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE); 1830 if (sgot == NULL || mips_elf_section_data (sgot) == NULL) 1831 return 0; 1832 1833 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info; 1834 if (g == NULL || g->global_gotsym == NULL) 1835 return 0; 1836 1837 return g->global_gotsym->dynindx; 1838 } 1839 1840 /* Returns the GOT offset at which the indicated address can be found. 1841 If there is not yet a GOT entry for this value, create one. Returns 1842 -1 if no satisfactory GOT offset can be found. */ 1843 1844 static bfd_vma 1845 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 1846 bfd_vma value) 1847 { 1848 asection *sgot; 1849 struct mips_got_info *g; 1850 struct mips_got_entry *entry; 1851 1852 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot); 1853 1854 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value); 1855 if (entry) 1856 return entry->gotidx; 1857 else 1858 return MINUS_ONE; 1859 } 1860 1861 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */ 1862 1863 static bfd_vma 1864 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 1865 { 1866 bfd_vma index; 1867 asection *sgot; 1868 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg; 1869 long global_got_dynindx = 0; 1870 1871 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot); 1872 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd) 1873 { 1874 struct mips_got_entry e, *p; 1875 1876 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0); 1877 1878 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd); 1879 if (g->next != gg) 1880 { 1881 e.abfd = ibfd; 1882 e.symndx = -1; 1883 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h; 1884 1885 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e); 1886 1887 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0); 1888 return p->gotidx; 1889 } 1890 } 1891 1892 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL) 1893 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx; 1894 1895 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic 1896 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater 1897 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT 1898 offset. */ 1899 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx); 1900 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno) 1901 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd)); 1902 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->_raw_size); 1903 1904 return index; 1905 } 1906 1907 /* Find a GOT entry that is within 32KB of the VALUE. These entries 1908 are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e., 1909 within 32KB of GP. Return the index into the GOT for this page, 1910 and store the offset from this entry to the desired address in 1911 OFFSETP, if it is non-NULL. */ 1912 1913 static bfd_vma 1914 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 1915 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp) 1916 { 1917 asection *sgot; 1918 struct mips_got_info *g; 1919 bfd_vma index; 1920 struct mips_got_entry *entry; 1921 1922 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot); 1923 1924 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, 1925 (value + 0x8000) 1926 & (~(bfd_vma)0xffff)); 1927 1928 if (!entry) 1929 return MINUS_ONE; 1930 1931 index = entry->gotidx; 1932 1933 if (offsetp) 1934 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address; 1935 1936 return index; 1937 } 1938 1939 /* Find a GOT entry whose higher-order 16 bits are the same as those 1940 for value. Return the index into the GOT for this entry. */ 1941 1942 static bfd_vma 1943 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 1944 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external) 1945 { 1946 asection *sgot; 1947 struct mips_got_info *g; 1948 struct mips_got_entry *entry; 1949 1950 if (! external) 1951 { 1952 /* Although the ABI says that it is "the high-order 16 bits" that we 1953 want, it is really the %high value. The complete value is 1954 calculated with a `addiu' of a LO16 relocation, just as with a 1955 HI16/LO16 pair. */ 1956 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16; 1957 } 1958 1959 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot); 1960 1961 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value); 1962 if (entry) 1963 return entry->gotidx; 1964 else 1965 return MINUS_ONE; 1966 } 1967 1968 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position 1969 in the GOT. */ 1970 1971 static bfd_vma 1972 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd, 1973 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index) 1974 { 1975 asection *sgot; 1976 bfd_vma gp; 1977 struct mips_got_info *g; 1978 1979 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot); 1980 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd) 1981 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd); 1982 1983 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp; 1984 } 1985 1986 /* Create a local GOT entry for VALUE. Return the index of the entry, 1987 or -1 if it could not be created. */ 1988 1989 static struct mips_got_entry * 1990 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, 1991 struct mips_got_info *gg, 1992 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value) 1993 { 1994 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc; 1995 struct mips_got_info *g; 1996 1997 entry.abfd = NULL; 1998 entry.symndx = -1; 1999 entry.d.address = value; 2000 2001 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd); 2002 if (g == NULL) 2003 { 2004 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd); 2005 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 2006 } 2007 2008 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, 2009 INSERT); 2010 if (*loc) 2011 return *loc; 2012 2013 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++; 2014 2015 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry); 2016 2017 if (! *loc) 2018 return NULL; 2019 2020 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry); 2021 2022 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno) 2023 { 2024 (*loc)->gotidx = -1; 2025 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */ 2026 (*_bfd_error_handler) 2027 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries")); 2028 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 2029 return NULL; 2030 } 2031 2032 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value, 2033 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx)); 2034 2035 return *loc; 2036 } 2037 2038 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries 2039 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space 2040 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols 2041 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During 2042 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the 2043 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */ 2044 2045 static bfd_boolean 2046 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local) 2047 { 2048 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd; 2049 struct mips_got_info *g; 2050 bfd *dynobj; 2051 2052 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 2053 2054 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL); 2055 2056 hsd.low = NULL; 2057 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx = 2058 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount 2059 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info 2060 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the 2061 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are 2062 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't 2063 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they 2064 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting 2065 too large offsets. */ 2066 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0); 2067 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local; 2068 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) 2069 elf_hash_table (info)), 2070 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f, 2071 &hsd); 2072 2073 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to 2074 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */ 2075 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx); 2076 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx 2077 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount); 2078 2079 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol 2080 table index in the GOT. */ 2081 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low; 2082 2083 return TRUE; 2084 } 2085 2086 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic 2087 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic 2088 index. */ 2089 2090 static bfd_boolean 2091 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data) 2092 { 2093 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data; 2094 2095 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 2096 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 2097 2098 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting 2099 at all. */ 2100 if (h->root.dynindx == -1) 2101 return TRUE; 2102 2103 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly 2104 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are 2105 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get 2106 -1. */ 2107 if (h->root.got.offset == 2) 2108 { 2109 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx) 2110 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 2111 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++; 2112 } 2113 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1) 2114 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++; 2115 else 2116 { 2117 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx; 2118 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 2119 } 2120 2121 return TRUE; 2122 } 2123 2124 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic 2125 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for 2126 posterity. */ 2127 2128 static bfd_boolean 2129 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 2130 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 2131 struct mips_got_info *g) 2132 { 2133 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc; 2134 2135 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol 2136 table. */ 2137 if (h->dynindx == -1) 2138 { 2139 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other)) 2140 { 2141 case STV_INTERNAL: 2142 case STV_HIDDEN: 2143 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE); 2144 break; 2145 } 2146 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 2147 return FALSE; 2148 } 2149 2150 entry.abfd = abfd; 2151 entry.symndx = -1; 2152 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 2153 2154 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, 2155 INSERT); 2156 2157 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't 2158 need to do it again. */ 2159 if (*loc) 2160 return TRUE; 2161 2162 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry); 2163 2164 if (! *loc) 2165 return FALSE; 2166 2167 entry.gotidx = -1; 2168 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry); 2169 2170 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE) 2171 return TRUE; 2172 2173 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that 2174 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the 2175 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */ 2176 h->got.offset = 1; 2177 2178 return TRUE; 2179 } 2180 2181 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol 2182 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */ 2183 2184 static bfd_boolean 2185 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend, 2186 struct mips_got_info *g) 2187 { 2188 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc; 2189 2190 entry.abfd = abfd; 2191 entry.symndx = symndx; 2192 entry.d.addend = addend; 2193 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) 2194 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT); 2195 2196 if (*loc) 2197 return TRUE; 2198 2199 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++; 2200 2201 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry); 2202 2203 if (! *loc) 2204 return FALSE; 2205 2206 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry); 2207 2208 return TRUE; 2209 } 2210 2211 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */ 2212 2213 static hashval_t 2214 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_) 2215 { 2216 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry 2217 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_; 2218 2219 return entry->bfd->id; 2220 } 2221 2222 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */ 2223 2224 static int 2225 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2) 2226 { 2227 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1 2228 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1; 2229 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2 2230 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2; 2231 2232 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd; 2233 } 2234 2235 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBDF. G must 2236 be the master GOT data. */ 2237 2238 static struct mips_got_info * 2239 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd) 2240 { 2241 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p; 2242 2243 if (! g->bfd2got) 2244 return g; 2245 2246 e.bfd = ibfd; 2247 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e); 2248 return p ? p->g : NULL; 2249 } 2250 2251 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global 2252 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each 2253 bfd requires. */ 2254 2255 static int 2256 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p) 2257 { 2258 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp; 2259 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p; 2260 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got; 2261 struct mips_got_info *g; 2262 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot; 2263 void **bfdgotp; 2264 2265 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if 2266 none exists. */ 2267 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd; 2268 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT); 2269 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp; 2270 2271 if (bfdgot != NULL) 2272 g = bfdgot->g; 2273 else 2274 { 2275 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc 2276 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash)); 2277 2278 if (bfdgot == NULL) 2279 { 2280 arg->obfd = 0; 2281 return 0; 2282 } 2283 2284 *bfdgotp = bfdgot; 2285 2286 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd; 2287 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *) 2288 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info)); 2289 if (g == NULL) 2290 { 2291 arg->obfd = 0; 2292 return 0; 2293 } 2294 2295 g->global_gotsym = NULL; 2296 g->global_gotno = 0; 2297 g->local_gotno = 0; 2298 g->assigned_gotno = -1; 2299 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash, 2300 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL); 2301 if (g->got_entries == NULL) 2302 { 2303 arg->obfd = 0; 2304 return 0; 2305 } 2306 2307 g->bfd2got = NULL; 2308 g->next = NULL; 2309 } 2310 2311 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */ 2312 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT); 2313 if (*entryp != NULL) 2314 return 1; 2315 2316 *entryp = entry; 2317 2318 if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local) 2319 ++g->local_gotno; 2320 else 2321 ++g->global_gotno; 2322 2323 return 1; 2324 } 2325 2326 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much 2327 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit 2328 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global 2329 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got, 2330 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got 2331 and then make make the new got current. */ 2332 2333 static int 2334 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p) 2335 { 2336 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got 2337 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_; 2338 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p; 2339 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno; 2340 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno; 2341 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count; 2342 2343 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as 2344 a starting point for the primary GOT. */ 2345 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount <= maxcnt) 2346 { 2347 arg->primary = bfd2got->g; 2348 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount; 2349 } 2350 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of 2351 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we 2352 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */ 2353 else if (arg->primary 2354 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount) <= maxcnt) 2355 { 2356 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g; 2357 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno; 2358 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno; 2359 2360 bfd2got->g = arg->primary; 2361 2362 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, 2363 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, 2364 arg); 2365 if (arg->obfd == NULL) 2366 return 0; 2367 2368 htab_delete (g->got_entries); 2369 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual 2370 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash 2371 table anyway. */ 2372 2373 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno); 2374 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno); 2375 2376 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno 2377 + arg->primary->global_gotno; 2378 } 2379 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */ 2380 else if (arg->current 2381 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount <= maxcnt) 2382 { 2383 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g; 2384 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno; 2385 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno; 2386 2387 bfd2got->g = arg->current; 2388 2389 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, 2390 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, 2391 arg); 2392 if (arg->obfd == NULL) 2393 return 0; 2394 2395 htab_delete (g->got_entries); 2396 2397 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno); 2398 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno); 2399 2400 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno 2401 + arg->current->global_gotno; 2402 } 2403 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it 2404 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation 2405 overflows anyway. */ 2406 else 2407 { 2408 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current; 2409 arg->current = bfd2got->g; 2410 2411 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount; 2412 } 2413 2414 return 1; 2415 } 2416 2417 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used 2418 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary 2419 got) to the given VALUE. 2420 2421 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must 2422 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of 2423 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the 2424 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the 2425 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size 2426 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a 2427 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is 2428 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function 2429 stub. */ 2430 static int 2431 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p) 2432 { 2433 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp; 2434 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg 2435 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p; 2436 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g; 2437 2438 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1 2439 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1) 2440 { 2441 if (g) 2442 { 2443 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL); 2444 2445 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++; 2446 if (arg->info->shared 2447 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created 2448 && ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 2449 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0) 2450 && ((entry->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 2451 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))) 2452 ++arg->needed_relocs; 2453 } 2454 else 2455 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value; 2456 } 2457 2458 return 1; 2459 } 2460 2461 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over 2462 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */ 2463 static int 2464 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 2465 { 2466 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp; 2467 2468 if (entry->abfd != NULL 2469 && entry->symndx == -1 2470 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1) 2471 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE; 2472 2473 return 1; 2474 } 2475 2476 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry 2477 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer 2478 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may 2479 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate 2480 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so 2481 the traversal must be restarted. */ 2482 static int 2483 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p) 2484 { 2485 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp; 2486 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p; 2487 2488 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1) 2489 { 2490 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h; 2491 2492 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 2493 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 2494 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 2495 2496 if (entry->d.h == h) 2497 return 1; 2498 2499 entry->d.h = h; 2500 2501 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert 2502 it, and get the traversal restarted. */ 2503 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry)) 2504 { 2505 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp); 2506 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT); 2507 if (! *entryp) 2508 *entryp = entry; 2509 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have 2510 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the 2511 process. */ 2512 *(htab_t *)p = NULL; 2513 return 0; 2514 } 2515 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's 2516 either too early or too late for that at this point. */ 2517 } 2518 2519 return 1; 2520 } 2521 2522 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final 2523 locations. */ 2524 static void 2525 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g) 2526 { 2527 htab_t got_entries; 2528 2529 do 2530 { 2531 got_entries = g->got_entries; 2532 2533 htab_traverse (got_entries, 2534 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry, 2535 &got_entries); 2536 } 2537 while (got_entries == NULL); 2538 } 2539 2540 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of 2541 the primary GOT. */ 2542 static bfd_vma 2543 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd) 2544 { 2545 if (g->bfd2got == NULL) 2546 return 0; 2547 2548 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd); 2549 if (! g) 2550 return 0; 2551 2552 BFD_ASSERT (g->next); 2553 2554 g = g->next; 2555 2556 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd); 2557 } 2558 2559 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into 2560 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */ 2561 2562 static bfd_boolean 2563 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 2564 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got, 2565 bfd_size_type pages) 2566 { 2567 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg; 2568 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg; 2569 struct mips_got_info *gg; 2570 unsigned int assign; 2571 2572 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash, 2573 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL); 2574 if (g->bfd2got == NULL) 2575 return FALSE; 2576 2577 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got; 2578 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd; 2579 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info; 2580 2581 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a 2582 map from bfd to got info while at that. */ 2583 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g); 2584 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg); 2585 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL) 2586 return FALSE; 2587 2588 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL; 2589 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL; 2590 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could 2591 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd 2592 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */ 2593 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (abfd) 2594 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd)) 2595 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO - pages); 2596 2597 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they 2598 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them 2599 to be the primary GOT. */ 2600 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg); 2601 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL) 2602 return FALSE; 2603 2604 /* If we find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */ 2605 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL) 2606 { 2607 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *) 2608 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info)); 2609 if (g->next == NULL) 2610 return FALSE; 2611 2612 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL; 2613 g->next->global_gotno = 0; 2614 g->next->local_gotno = 0; 2615 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0; 2616 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash, 2617 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, 2618 NULL); 2619 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL) 2620 return FALSE; 2621 g->next->bfd2got = NULL; 2622 } 2623 else 2624 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary; 2625 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current; 2626 2627 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */ 2628 gg = g; 2629 g = g->next; 2630 2631 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going 2632 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we 2633 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it. 2634 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the 2635 list. */ 2636 { 2637 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot; 2638 void **bfdgotp; 2639 2640 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc 2641 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash)); 2642 2643 if (bfdgot == NULL) 2644 return FALSE; 2645 2646 bfdgot->bfd = abfd; 2647 bfdgot->g = g; 2648 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT); 2649 2650 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL); 2651 *bfdgotp = bfdgot; 2652 } 2653 2654 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced 2655 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so 2656 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually 2657 referenced. 2658 2659 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down 2660 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic 2661 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from 2662 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT 2663 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux 2664 follows IRIX's practice. 2665 2666 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count 2667 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with 2668 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where 2669 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is 2670 preserved. */ 2671 if (1) 2672 { 2673 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno; 2674 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno; 2675 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2; 2676 } 2677 else 2678 { 2679 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize 2680 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use 2681 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined. 2682 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global 2683 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that 2684 their entries can be omitted. */ 2685 gg->assigned_gotno = 0; 2686 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1; 2687 } 2688 2689 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior 2690 depends on the setting of VALUE). */ 2691 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL; 2692 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset, 2693 &set_got_offset_arg); 2694 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1; 2695 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset, 2696 &set_got_offset_arg); 2697 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1)) 2698 return FALSE; 2699 2700 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges. 2701 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local 2702 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by 2703 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make 2704 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the 2705 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To 2706 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving 2707 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links, 2708 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of 2709 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial 2710 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT 2711 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it 2712 points back to the master GOT. */ 2713 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno; 2714 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno; 2715 assign = 0; 2716 gg->next = gg; 2717 2718 do 2719 { 2720 struct mips_got_info *gn; 2721 2722 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO; 2723 g->assigned_gotno = assign; 2724 g->local_gotno += assign + pages; 2725 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno; 2726 2727 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed 2728 list that gg points to. */ 2729 gn = g->next; 2730 g->next = gg->next; 2731 gg->next = g; 2732 g = gn; 2733 2734 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for 2735 stubs. */ 2736 if (g) 2737 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL); 2738 } 2739 while (g); 2740 2741 got->_raw_size = (gg->next->local_gotno 2742 + gg->next->global_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd); 2743 2744 return TRUE; 2745 } 2746 2747 2748 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with 2749 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */ 2750 2751 static const Elf_Internal_Rela * 2752 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type, 2753 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation, 2754 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend) 2755 { 2756 /* According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must be 2757 immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next 2758 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several 2759 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 2760 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar 2761 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC. */ 2762 while (relocation < relend) 2763 { 2764 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type) 2765 return relocation; 2766 2767 ++relocation; 2768 } 2769 2770 /* We didn't find it. */ 2771 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 2772 return NULL; 2773 } 2774 2775 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */ 2776 2777 static bfd_boolean 2778 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd, 2779 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation, 2780 asection **local_sections, 2781 bfd_boolean check_forced) 2782 { 2783 unsigned long r_symndx; 2784 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 2785 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 2786 size_t extsymoff; 2787 2788 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info); 2789 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr; 2790 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info; 2791 2792 if (r_symndx < extsymoff) 2793 return TRUE; 2794 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL) 2795 return TRUE; 2796 2797 if (check_forced) 2798 { 2799 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol 2800 was forced local. */ 2801 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 2802 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]; 2803 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */ 2804 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 2805 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 2806 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 2807 if ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0) 2808 return TRUE; 2809 } 2810 2811 return FALSE; 2812 } 2813 2814 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */ 2815 2816 bfd_vma 2817 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits) 2818 { 2819 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1))) 2820 /* VALUE is negative. */ 2821 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits; 2822 2823 return value; 2824 } 2825 2826 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum 2827 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of 2828 BITS. */ 2829 2830 static bfd_boolean 2831 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits) 2832 { 2833 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value; 2834 2835 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1) 2836 /* The value is too big. */ 2837 return TRUE; 2838 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1))) 2839 /* The value is too small. */ 2840 return TRUE; 2841 2842 /* All is well. */ 2843 return FALSE; 2844 } 2845 2846 /* Calculate the %high function. */ 2847 2848 static bfd_vma 2849 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value) 2850 { 2851 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff; 2852 } 2853 2854 /* Calculate the %higher function. */ 2855 2856 static bfd_vma 2857 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 2858 { 2859 #ifdef BFD64 2860 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff; 2861 #else 2862 abort (); 2863 return (bfd_vma) -1; 2864 #endif 2865 } 2866 2867 /* Calculate the %highest function. */ 2868 2869 static bfd_vma 2870 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 2871 { 2872 #ifdef BFD64 2873 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff; 2874 #else 2875 abort (); 2876 return (bfd_vma) -1; 2877 #endif 2878 } 2879 2880 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */ 2881 2882 static bfd_boolean 2883 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section 2884 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 2885 { 2886 flagword flags; 2887 register asection *s; 2888 2889 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL) 2890 { 2891 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED 2892 | SEC_READONLY); 2893 2894 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".compact_rel"); 2895 if (s == NULL 2896 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags) 2897 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2898 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd))) 2899 return FALSE; 2900 2901 s->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel); 2902 } 2903 2904 return TRUE; 2905 } 2906 2907 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */ 2908 2909 static bfd_boolean 2910 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 2911 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude) 2912 { 2913 flagword flags; 2914 register asection *s; 2915 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 2916 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh; 2917 struct mips_got_info *g; 2918 bfd_size_type amt; 2919 2920 /* This function may be called more than once. */ 2921 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE); 2922 if (s) 2923 { 2924 if (! maybe_exclude) 2925 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE; 2926 return TRUE; 2927 } 2928 2929 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY 2930 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED); 2931 2932 if (maybe_exclude) 2933 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 2934 2935 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded 2936 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */ 2937 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".got"); 2938 if (s == NULL 2939 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags) 2940 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4)) 2941 return FALSE; 2942 2943 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the 2944 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we 2945 are not creating a global offset table. */ 2946 bh = NULL; 2947 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol 2948 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s, 2949 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh))) 2950 return FALSE; 2951 2952 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh; 2953 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF; 2954 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR; 2955 h->type = STT_OBJECT; 2956 2957 if (info->shared 2958 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 2959 return FALSE; 2960 2961 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info); 2962 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt); 2963 if (g == NULL) 2964 return FALSE; 2965 g->global_gotsym = NULL; 2966 g->global_gotno = 0; 2967 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO; 2968 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO; 2969 g->bfd2got = NULL; 2970 g->next = NULL; 2971 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash, 2972 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL); 2973 if (g->got_entries == NULL) 2974 return FALSE; 2975 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g; 2976 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags 2977 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL; 2978 2979 return TRUE; 2980 } 2981 2982 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from 2983 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this 2984 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored. 2985 2986 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP. 2987 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this 2988 relocation must be JALX. 2989 2990 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no 2991 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if 2992 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an 2993 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */ 2994 2995 static bfd_reloc_status_type 2996 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd, 2997 asection *input_section, 2998 struct bfd_link_info *info, 2999 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation, 3000 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto, 3001 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms, 3002 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep, 3003 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp, 3004 bfd_boolean save_addend) 3005 { 3006 /* The eventual value we will return. */ 3007 bfd_vma value; 3008 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is 3009 occurring. */ 3010 bfd_vma symbol = 0; 3011 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or 3012 shared object file being produced. */ 3013 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE; 3014 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being 3015 relocated. */ 3016 bfd_vma p; 3017 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */ 3018 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE; 3019 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of 3020 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides 3021 during execution. */ 3022 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE; 3023 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is 3024 located. */ 3025 asection *sec = NULL; 3026 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL; 3027 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local 3028 symbol. */ 3029 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p; 3030 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */ 3031 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE; 3032 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 3033 size_t extsymoff; 3034 unsigned long r_symndx; 3035 int r_type; 3036 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the 3037 relocation value. */ 3038 bfd_boolean overflowed_p; 3039 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */ 3040 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE; 3041 3042 /* Parse the relocation. */ 3043 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info); 3044 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info); 3045 p = (input_section->output_section->vma 3046 + input_section->output_offset 3047 + relocation->r_offset); 3048 3049 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */ 3050 overflowed_p = FALSE; 3051 3052 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset 3053 used in the array of hash table entries. */ 3054 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr; 3055 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation, 3056 local_sections, FALSE); 3057 was_local_p = local_p; 3058 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) 3059 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info; 3060 else 3061 { 3062 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols 3063 must come before globals. */ 3064 extsymoff = 0; 3065 } 3066 3067 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */ 3068 if (local_p) 3069 { 3070 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 3071 3072 sym = local_syms + r_symndx; 3073 sec = local_sections[r_symndx]; 3074 3075 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset; 3076 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION 3077 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)) 3078 symbol += sym->st_value; 3079 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) 3080 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION) 3081 { 3082 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend); 3083 addend -= symbol; 3084 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset; 3085 } 3086 3087 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */ 3088 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16) 3089 ++symbol; 3090 3091 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */ 3092 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd, 3093 symtab_hdr->sh_link, 3094 sym->st_name); 3095 if (*namep == '\0') 3096 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec); 3097 3098 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16); 3099 } 3100 else 3101 { 3102 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */ 3103 3104 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */ 3105 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 3106 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]); 3107 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */ 3108 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 3109 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 3110 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 3111 3112 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */ 3113 *namep = h->root.root.root.string; 3114 3115 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a 3116 symbol must always be a global symbol. */ 3117 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0 3118 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd)) 3119 { 3120 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with 3121 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */ 3122 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16) 3123 return bfd_reloc_notsupported; 3124 3125 gp_disp_p = TRUE; 3126 } 3127 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that 3128 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the 3129 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not 3130 its defined. */ 3131 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 3132 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) 3133 && h->root.root.u.def.section) 3134 { 3135 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section; 3136 if (sec->output_section) 3137 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value 3138 + sec->output_section->vma 3139 + sec->output_offset); 3140 else 3141 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value; 3142 } 3143 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak) 3144 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving 3145 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions 3146 and check to see if they exist by looking at their 3147 addresses. */ 3148 symbol = 0; 3149 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE 3150 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT) 3151 symbol = 0; 3152 else if (strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0 || 3153 strcmp (*namep, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0) 3154 { 3155 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a 3156 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol 3157 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections. 3158 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0. 3159 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table 3160 somehow as well. */ 3161 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared); 3162 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL); 3163 symbol = 0; 3164 } 3165 else 3166 { 3167 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) 3168 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd, 3169 input_section, relocation->r_offset, 3170 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR) 3171 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other)))) 3172 return bfd_reloc_undefined; 3173 symbol = 0; 3174 } 3175 3176 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16); 3177 } 3178 3179 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we 3180 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in* 3181 a stub. */ 3182 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable 3183 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL) 3184 || (local_p && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL 3185 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL)) 3186 && !mips_elf_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section)) 3187 { 3188 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should 3189 have already noticed that we were going to need the 3190 stub. */ 3191 if (local_p) 3192 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx]; 3193 else 3194 { 3195 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub); 3196 sec = h->fn_stub; 3197 } 3198 3199 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset; 3200 } 3201 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we 3202 need to redirect the call to the stub. */ 3203 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable 3204 && h != NULL 3205 && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL) 3206 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p) 3207 { 3208 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure 3209 out which one to use by seeing which one appears in the input 3210 file. */ 3211 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL) 3212 { 3213 asection *o; 3214 3215 sec = NULL; 3216 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next) 3217 { 3218 if (strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o), 3219 CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0) 3220 { 3221 sec = h->call_fp_stub; 3222 break; 3223 } 3224 } 3225 if (sec == NULL) 3226 sec = h->call_stub; 3227 } 3228 else if (h->call_stub != NULL) 3229 sec = h->call_stub; 3230 else 3231 sec = h->call_fp_stub; 3232 3233 BFD_ASSERT (sec->_raw_size > 0); 3234 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset; 3235 } 3236 3237 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the 3238 special jalx instruction. */ 3239 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable 3240 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p) 3241 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p))); 3242 3243 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation, 3244 local_sections, TRUE); 3245 3246 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value, 3247 and we're going to need it, get it now. */ 3248 switch (r_type) 3249 { 3250 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE: 3251 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST: 3252 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't 3253 bind locally. */ 3254 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1); 3255 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST) 3256 break; 3257 /* Fall through. */ 3258 3259 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 3260 case R_MIPS_GOT16: 3261 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP: 3262 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16: 3263 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 3264 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16: 3265 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 3266 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */ 3267 if (!local_p) 3268 { 3269 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a 3270 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the 3271 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added 3272 as GOT_OFST. */ 3273 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE); 3274 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, 3275 input_bfd, 3276 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h); 3277 if (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created 3278 || (info->shared 3279 && (info->symbolic || h->root.dynindx == -1) 3280 && (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR))) 3281 { 3282 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The 3283 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local. 3284 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */ 3285 bfd *tmpbfd = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 3286 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (tmpbfd, FALSE); 3287 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (tmpbfd, symbol, sgot->contents + g); 3288 } 3289 } 3290 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16) 3291 /* There's no need to create a local GOT entry here; the 3292 calculation for a local GOT16 entry does not involve G. */ 3293 break; 3294 else 3295 { 3296 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, 3297 info, symbol + addend); 3298 if (g == MINUS_ONE) 3299 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 3300 } 3301 3302 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */ 3303 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, 3304 abfd, input_bfd, g); 3305 break; 3306 3307 case R_MIPS_HI16: 3308 case R_MIPS_LO16: 3309 case R_MIPS16_GPREL: 3310 case R_MIPS_GPREL16: 3311 case R_MIPS_GPREL32: 3312 case R_MIPS_LITERAL: 3313 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd); 3314 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd); 3315 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj) 3316 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, 3317 mips_elf_got_info 3318 (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, NULL), 3319 input_bfd); 3320 break; 3321 3322 default: 3323 break; 3324 } 3325 3326 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */ 3327 switch (r_type) 3328 { 3329 case R_MIPS_NONE: 3330 return bfd_reloc_continue; 3331 3332 case R_MIPS_16: 3333 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16); 3334 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3335 break; 3336 3337 case R_MIPS_32: 3338 case R_MIPS_REL32: 3339 case R_MIPS_64: 3340 if ((info->shared 3341 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created 3342 && h != NULL 3343 && ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 3344 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0) 3345 && ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 3346 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))) 3347 && r_symndx != 0 3348 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 3349 { 3350 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is 3351 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know 3352 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation 3353 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic 3354 linker. */ 3355 value = addend; 3356 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd, 3357 info, 3358 relocation, 3359 h, 3360 sec, 3361 symbol, 3362 &value, 3363 input_section)) 3364 return bfd_reloc_undefined; 3365 } 3366 else 3367 { 3368 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32) 3369 value = symbol + addend; 3370 else 3371 value = addend; 3372 } 3373 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3374 break; 3375 3376 case R_MIPS_PC32: 3377 case R_MIPS_PC64: 3378 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16: 3379 value = symbol + addend - p; 3380 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3381 break; 3382 3383 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2: 3384 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p; 3385 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18); 3386 value = (value >> 2) & howto->dst_mask; 3387 break; 3388 3389 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16: 3390 /* Instead of subtracting 'p' here, we should be subtracting the 3391 equivalent value for the LO part of the reloc, since the value 3392 here is relative to that address. Because that's not easy to do, 3393 we adjust 'addend' in _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(). See also 3394 the comment there for more information. */ 3395 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - p); 3396 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3397 break; 3398 3399 case R_MIPS16_26: 3400 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an 3401 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into 3402 the output file that's different. That's handled in 3403 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the 3404 R_MIPS_26 case here. */ 3405 case R_MIPS_26: 3406 if (local_p) 3407 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2; 3408 else 3409 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2; 3410 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3411 break; 3412 3413 case R_MIPS_HI16: 3414 if (!gp_disp_p) 3415 { 3416 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol); 3417 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3418 } 3419 else 3420 { 3421 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p); 3422 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3423 } 3424 break; 3425 3426 case R_MIPS_LO16: 3427 if (!gp_disp_p) 3428 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask; 3429 else 3430 { 3431 value = addend + gp - p + 4; 3432 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation 3433 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against 3434 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload 3435 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like 3436 this: 3437 3438 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp) 3439 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp) 3440 addu $gp,$gp,$t9 3441 3442 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called, 3443 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16 3444 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the 3445 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow. 3446 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do 3447 not check for overflow here. */ 3448 } 3449 break; 3450 3451 case R_MIPS_LITERAL: 3452 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this 3453 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge 3454 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work 3455 here. */ 3456 3457 /* Fall through. */ 3458 3459 case R_MIPS16_GPREL: 3460 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as 3461 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different 3462 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the 3463 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */ 3464 case R_MIPS_GPREL16: 3465 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the 3466 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone, 3467 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */ 3468 if (howto->partial_inplace) 3469 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16); 3470 value = symbol + addend - gp; 3471 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will 3472 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate 3473 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this 3474 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied 3475 to them before. */ 3476 if (was_local_p) 3477 value += gp0; 3478 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3479 break; 3480 3481 case R_MIPS_GOT16: 3482 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 3483 if (local_p) 3484 { 3485 bfd_boolean forced; 3486 3487 /* The special case is when the symbol is forced to be local. We 3488 need the full address in the GOT since no R_MIPS_LO16 relocation 3489 follows. */ 3490 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation, 3491 local_sections, FALSE); 3492 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info, 3493 symbol + addend, forced); 3494 if (value == MINUS_ONE) 3495 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 3496 value 3497 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, 3498 abfd, input_bfd, value); 3499 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3500 break; 3501 } 3502 3503 /* Fall through. */ 3504 3505 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP: 3506 got_disp: 3507 value = g; 3508 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3509 break; 3510 3511 case R_MIPS_GPREL32: 3512 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp); 3513 if (!save_addend) 3514 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3515 break; 3516 3517 case R_MIPS_PC16: 3518 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16) + symbol - p; 3519 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3520 break; 3521 3522 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16: 3523 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 3524 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically. 3525 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations 3526 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */ 3527 value = g; 3528 value = mips_elf_high (value); 3529 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3530 break; 3531 3532 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16: 3533 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 3534 value = g & howto->dst_mask; 3535 break; 3536 3537 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE: 3538 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay 3539 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to 3540 0. */ 3541 if (! local_p) 3542 goto got_disp; 3543 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL); 3544 if (value == MINUS_ONE) 3545 return bfd_reloc_outofrange; 3546 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, 3547 abfd, input_bfd, value); 3548 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3549 break; 3550 3551 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST: 3552 if (local_p) 3553 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value); 3554 else 3555 value = addend; 3556 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16); 3557 break; 3558 3559 case R_MIPS_SUB: 3560 value = symbol - addend; 3561 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3562 break; 3563 3564 case R_MIPS_HIGHER: 3565 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol); 3566 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3567 break; 3568 3569 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST: 3570 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol); 3571 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3572 break; 3573 3574 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP: 3575 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset; 3576 value &= howto->dst_mask; 3577 break; 3578 3579 case R_MIPS_PJUMP: 3580 case R_MIPS_JALR: 3581 /* Both of these may be ignored. R_MIPS_JALR is an optimization 3582 hint; we could improve performance by honoring that hint. */ 3583 return bfd_reloc_continue; 3584 3585 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT: 3586 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY: 3587 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */ 3588 return bfd_reloc_continue; 3589 3590 default: 3591 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */ 3592 return bfd_reloc_notsupported; 3593 } 3594 3595 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */ 3596 *valuep = value; 3597 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok; 3598 } 3599 3600 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */ 3601 3602 static bfd_vma 3603 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto, 3604 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation, 3605 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents) 3606 { 3607 bfd_vma x; 3608 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset; 3609 3610 /* Obtain the bytes. */ 3611 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location); 3612 3613 if ((ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26 3614 || ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info) == R_MIPS16_GPREL) 3615 && bfd_little_endian (input_bfd)) 3616 /* The two 16-bit words will be reversed on a little-endian system. 3617 See mips_elf_perform_relocation for more details. */ 3618 x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16)); 3619 3620 return x; 3621 } 3622 3623 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the 3624 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the 3625 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the 3626 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used 3627 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is 3628 unconditionally converted to JALX. 3629 3630 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */ 3631 3632 static bfd_boolean 3633 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info, 3634 reloc_howto_type *howto, 3635 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation, 3636 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd, 3637 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents, 3638 bfd_boolean require_jalx) 3639 { 3640 bfd_vma x; 3641 bfd_byte *location; 3642 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info); 3643 3644 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */ 3645 location = contents + relocation->r_offset; 3646 3647 /* Obtain the current value. */ 3648 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents); 3649 3650 /* Clear the field we are setting. */ 3651 x &= ~howto->dst_mask; 3652 3653 /* If this is the R_MIPS16_26 relocation, we must store the 3654 value in a funny way. */ 3655 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26) 3656 { 3657 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions. 3658 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions 3659 are 32 bits. 3660 3661 The format of these instructions is: 3662 3663 +--------------+--------------------------------+ 3664 ! JALX ! X! Imm 20:16 ! Imm 25:21 ! 3665 +--------------+--------------------------------+ 3666 ! Immediate 15:0 ! 3667 +-----------------------------------------------+ 3668 3669 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx. 3670 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped. 3671 3672 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is 3673 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is 3674 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction. 3675 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a 3676 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is 3677 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2 3678 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a 3679 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian 3680 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped. 3681 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal 3682 instruction. 3683 3684 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit 3685 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the 3686 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as 3687 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the 3688 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the 3689 value as two 16-bit values. 3690 3691 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16, 3692 defined as 3693 3694 big-endian: 3695 +--------+----------------------+ 3696 | | | 3697 | | targ26-16 | 3698 |31 26|25 0| 3699 +--------+----------------------+ 3700 3701 little-endian: 3702 +----------+------+-------------+ 3703 | | | | 3704 | sub1 | | sub2 | 3705 |0 9|10 15|16 31| 3706 +----------+--------------------+ 3707 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is 3708 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)). 3709 3710 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is 3711 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2) 3712 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is 3713 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2) 3714 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff) */ 3715 3716 if (!info->relocatable) 3717 /* Shuffle the bits according to the formula above. */ 3718 value = (((value & 0x1f0000) << 5) 3719 | ((value & 0x3e00000) >> 5) 3720 | (value & 0xffff)); 3721 } 3722 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL) 3723 { 3724 /* R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16 3725 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this: 3726 3727 +--------------+--------------------------------+ 3728 ! EXTEND ! Imm 10:5 ! Imm 15:11 ! 3729 +--------------+--------------------------------+ 3730 ! Major ! rx ! ry ! Imm 4:0 ! 3731 +--------------+--------------------------------+ 3732 3733 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction 3734 opcode. 3735 3736 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the 3737 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that 3738 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field. 3739 3740 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As 3741 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a 3742 little-endian system. */ 3743 value = (((value & 0x7e0) << 16) 3744 | ((value & 0xf800) << 5) 3745 | (value & 0x1f)); 3746 } 3747 3748 /* Set the field. */ 3749 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask); 3750 3751 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */ 3752 if (require_jalx) 3753 { 3754 bfd_boolean ok; 3755 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26; 3756 bfd_vma jalx_opcode; 3757 3758 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */ 3759 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26) 3760 { 3761 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7)); 3762 jalx_opcode = 0x7; 3763 } 3764 else 3765 { 3766 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d)); 3767 jalx_opcode = 0x1d; 3768 } 3769 3770 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */ 3771 if (!ok) 3772 { 3773 (*_bfd_error_handler) 3774 (_("%s: %s+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"), 3775 bfd_archive_filename (input_bfd), 3776 input_section->name, 3777 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset); 3778 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 3779 return FALSE; 3780 } 3781 3782 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */ 3783 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26); 3784 } 3785 3786 /* Swap the high- and low-order 16 bits on little-endian systems 3787 when doing a MIPS16 relocation. */ 3788 if ((r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL || r_type == R_MIPS16_26) 3789 && bfd_little_endian (input_bfd)) 3790 x = (((x & 0xffff) << 16) | ((x & 0xffff0000) >> 16)); 3791 3792 /* Put the value into the output. */ 3793 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location); 3794 return TRUE; 3795 } 3796 3797 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */ 3798 3799 static bfd_boolean 3800 mips_elf_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section) 3801 { 3802 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section); 3803 3804 return (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0 3805 || strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0 3806 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0); 3807 } 3808 3809 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel.dyn section in ABFD. */ 3810 3811 static void 3812 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, unsigned int n) 3813 { 3814 asection *s; 3815 3816 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (abfd, FALSE); 3817 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 3818 3819 if (s->_raw_size == 0) 3820 { 3821 /* Make room for a null element. */ 3822 s->_raw_size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd); 3823 ++s->reloc_count; 3824 } 3825 s->_raw_size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd); 3826 } 3827 3828 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL 3829 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a 3830 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the 3831 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */ 3832 3833 static bfd_boolean 3834 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd, 3835 struct bfd_link_info *info, 3836 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, 3837 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, 3838 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol, 3839 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section) 3840 { 3841 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3]; 3842 bfd_boolean skip; 3843 asection *sreloc; 3844 bfd *dynobj; 3845 int r_type; 3846 3847 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info); 3848 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 3849 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE); 3850 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL); 3851 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL); 3852 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd) 3853 < sreloc->_raw_size); 3854 3855 skip = FALSE; 3856 outrel[0].r_offset = 3857 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset); 3858 outrel[1].r_offset = 3859 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset); 3860 outrel[2].r_offset = 3861 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset); 3862 3863 #if 0 3864 /* We begin by assuming that the offset for the dynamic relocation 3865 is the same as for the original relocation. We'll adjust this 3866 later to reflect the correct output offsets. */ 3867 if (input_section->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS) 3868 { 3869 outrel[1].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset; 3870 outrel[2].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset; 3871 } 3872 else 3873 { 3874 /* Except that in a stab section things are more complex. 3875 Because we compress stab information, the offset given in the 3876 relocation may not be the one we want; we must let the stabs 3877 machinery tell us the offset. */ 3878 outrel[1].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset; 3879 outrel[2].r_offset = outrel[0].r_offset; 3880 /* If we didn't need the relocation at all, this value will be 3881 -1. */ 3882 if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1) 3883 skip = TRUE; 3884 } 3885 #endif 3886 3887 if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1) 3888 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */ 3889 skip = TRUE; 3890 else if (outrel[0].r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2) 3891 { 3892 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of 3893 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect 3894 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */ 3895 skip = TRUE; 3896 *addendp += symbol; 3897 } 3898 3899 /* If we've decided to skip this relocation, just output an empty 3900 record. Note that R_MIPS_NONE == 0, so that this call to memset 3901 is a way of setting R_TYPE to R_MIPS_NONE. */ 3902 if (skip) 3903 memset (outrel, 0, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * 3); 3904 else 3905 { 3906 long indx; 3907 bfd_boolean defined_p; 3908 3909 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use 3910 in the relocation. */ 3911 if (h != NULL 3912 && (! info->symbolic || (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 3913 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0) 3914 /* h->root.dynindx may be -1 if this symbol was marked to 3915 become local. */ 3916 && h->root.dynindx != -1) 3917 { 3918 indx = h->root.dynindx; 3919 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 3920 defined_p = ((h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 3921 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) != 0); 3922 else 3923 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the 3924 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against 3925 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against 3926 undefined symbols. */ 3927 defined_p = FALSE; 3928 } 3929 else 3930 { 3931 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec)) 3932 indx = 0; 3933 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL) 3934 { 3935 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 3936 return FALSE; 3937 } 3938 else 3939 { 3940 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx; 3941 if (indx == 0) 3942 abort (); 3943 } 3944 3945 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section 3946 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative 3947 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to 3948 local symbols because we used to generate them 3949 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value, 3950 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In 3951 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to 3952 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting 3953 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're 3954 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient 3955 as well. */ 3956 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so, 3957 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have 3958 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations 3959 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */ 3960 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 3961 indx = 0; 3962 defined_p = TRUE; 3963 } 3964 3965 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and 3966 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must 3967 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table. 3968 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */ 3969 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32) 3970 *addendp += symbol; 3971 3972 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't 3973 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */ 3974 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx, 3975 R_MIPS_REL32); 3976 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should 3977 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the 3978 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as 3979 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all). 3980 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic 3981 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these 3982 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true, 3983 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so 3984 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per 3985 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an 3986 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a 3987 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */ 3988 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, 3989 ABI_64_P (output_bfd) 3990 ? R_MIPS_64 3991 : R_MIPS_NONE); 3992 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE); 3993 3994 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the 3995 correct location in the output file. */ 3996 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma 3997 + input_section->output_offset); 3998 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma 3999 + input_section->output_offset); 4000 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma 4001 + input_section->output_offset); 4002 } 4003 4004 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special 4005 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit 4006 relocation format is non-standard. */ 4007 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)) 4008 { 4009 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out) 4010 (output_bfd, &outrel[0], 4011 (sreloc->contents 4012 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel))); 4013 } 4014 else 4015 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out 4016 (output_bfd, &outrel[0], 4017 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel))); 4018 4019 /* We've now added another relocation. */ 4020 ++sreloc->reloc_count; 4021 4022 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker 4023 will be writing to it. */ 4024 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags 4025 |= SHF_WRITE; 4026 4027 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */ 4028 if (! skip && IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5) 4029 { 4030 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel"); 4031 bfd_byte *cr; 4032 4033 if (scpt) 4034 { 4035 Elf32_crinfo cptrel; 4036 4037 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG); 4038 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset 4039 + input_section->output_section->vma 4040 + input_section->output_offset); 4041 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32) 4042 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32); 4043 else 4044 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD); 4045 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0); 4046 cptrel.konst = *addendp; 4047 4048 cr = (scpt->contents 4049 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel)); 4050 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel, 4051 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr 4052 + scpt->reloc_count)); 4053 ++scpt->reloc_count; 4054 } 4055 } 4056 4057 return TRUE; 4058 } 4059 4060 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */ 4061 4062 unsigned long 4063 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags) 4064 { 4065 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) 4066 { 4067 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900: 4068 return bfd_mach_mips3900; 4069 4070 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010: 4071 return bfd_mach_mips4010; 4072 4073 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100: 4074 return bfd_mach_mips4100; 4075 4076 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111: 4077 return bfd_mach_mips4111; 4078 4079 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120: 4080 return bfd_mach_mips4120; 4081 4082 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650: 4083 return bfd_mach_mips4650; 4084 4085 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400: 4086 return bfd_mach_mips5400; 4087 4088 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500: 4089 return bfd_mach_mips5500; 4090 4091 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1: 4092 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1; 4093 4094 default: 4095 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) 4096 { 4097 default: 4098 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1: 4099 return bfd_mach_mips3000; 4100 break; 4101 4102 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2: 4103 return bfd_mach_mips6000; 4104 break; 4105 4106 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3: 4107 return bfd_mach_mips4000; 4108 break; 4109 4110 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4: 4111 return bfd_mach_mips8000; 4112 break; 4113 4114 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5: 4115 return bfd_mach_mips5; 4116 break; 4117 4118 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32: 4119 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32; 4120 break; 4121 4122 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64: 4123 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64; 4124 break; 4125 4126 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2: 4127 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2; 4128 break; 4129 4130 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2: 4131 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2; 4132 break; 4133 } 4134 } 4135 4136 return 0; 4137 } 4138 4139 /* Return printable name for ABI. */ 4140 4141 static INLINE char * 4142 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd) 4143 { 4144 flagword flags; 4145 4146 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags; 4147 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) 4148 { 4149 case 0: 4150 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd)) 4151 return "N32"; 4152 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd)) 4153 return "64"; 4154 else 4155 return "none"; 4156 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32: 4157 return "O32"; 4158 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64: 4159 return "O64"; 4160 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32: 4161 return "EABI32"; 4162 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64: 4163 return "EABI64"; 4164 default: 4165 return "unknown abi"; 4166 } 4167 } 4168 4169 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the 4170 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept 4171 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields 4172 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common 4173 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */ 4174 static asection mips_elf_scom_section; 4175 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol; 4176 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr; 4177 4178 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an 4179 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a 4180 definition in a shared library. */ 4181 static asection mips_elf_acom_section; 4182 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol; 4183 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr; 4184 4185 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use. 4186 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */ 4187 4188 void 4189 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym) 4190 { 4191 elf_symbol_type *elfsym; 4192 4193 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym; 4194 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx) 4195 { 4196 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON: 4197 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file. 4198 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can 4199 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared 4200 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes, 4201 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */ 4202 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL) 4203 { 4204 /* Initialize the acommon section. */ 4205 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon"; 4206 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC; 4207 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section; 4208 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol; 4209 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr; 4210 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon"; 4211 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM; 4212 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section; 4213 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol; 4214 } 4215 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section; 4216 break; 4217 4218 case SHN_COMMON: 4219 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically 4220 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */ 4221 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd) 4222 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6) 4223 break; 4224 /* Fall through. */ 4225 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON: 4226 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL) 4227 { 4228 /* Initialize the small common section. */ 4229 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon"; 4230 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON; 4231 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section; 4232 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol; 4233 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr; 4234 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon"; 4235 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM; 4236 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section; 4237 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol; 4238 } 4239 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section; 4240 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size; 4241 break; 4242 4243 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED: 4244 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr; 4245 break; 4246 4247 #if 0 /* for SGI_COMPAT */ 4248 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT: 4249 asym->section = mips_elf_text_section_ptr; 4250 break; 4251 4252 case SHN_MIPS_DATA: 4253 asym->section = mips_elf_data_section_ptr; 4254 break; 4255 #endif 4256 } 4257 } 4258 4259 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP 4260 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the 4261 same address. For example, if we have code like: 4262 4263 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp) 4264 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp) 4265 jalr $25 4266 4267 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program 4268 will jump there rather than to .text. 4269 4270 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols. 4271 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */ 4272 4273 bfd_boolean 4274 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd) 4275 { 4276 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd); 4277 } 4278 4279 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is 4280 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize 4281 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be 4282 a better way. */ 4283 4284 bfd_boolean 4285 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr) 4286 { 4287 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO 4288 && hdr->sh_size > 0) 4289 { 4290 bfd_byte buf[4]; 4291 4292 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo)); 4293 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL); 4294 4295 if (bfd_seek (abfd, 4296 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4, 4297 SEEK_SET) != 0) 4298 return FALSE; 4299 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf); 4300 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4) 4301 return FALSE; 4302 } 4303 4304 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS 4305 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL 4306 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL 4307 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL) 4308 { 4309 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend; 4310 4311 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the 4312 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents 4313 so that we don't have to read them again. 4314 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look 4315 through the section contents to see if there is an 4316 ODK_REGINFO structure. */ 4317 4318 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata; 4319 l = contents; 4320 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size; 4321 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend) 4322 { 4323 Elf_Internal_Options intopt; 4324 4325 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l, 4326 &intopt); 4327 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO) 4328 { 4329 bfd_byte buf[8]; 4330 4331 if (bfd_seek (abfd, 4332 (hdr->sh_offset 4333 + (l - contents) 4334 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) 4335 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)), 4336 SEEK_SET) != 0) 4337 return FALSE; 4338 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf); 4339 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8) 4340 return FALSE; 4341 } 4342 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO) 4343 { 4344 bfd_byte buf[4]; 4345 4346 if (bfd_seek (abfd, 4347 (hdr->sh_offset 4348 + (l - contents) 4349 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) 4350 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)), 4351 SEEK_SET) != 0) 4352 return FALSE; 4353 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf); 4354 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4) 4355 return FALSE; 4356 } 4357 l += intopt.size; 4358 } 4359 } 4360 4361 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL) 4362 { 4363 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section); 4364 4365 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0 4366 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0 4367 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0) 4368 { 4369 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL; 4370 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS; 4371 } 4372 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0) 4373 { 4374 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL; 4375 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS; 4376 } 4377 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0) 4378 { 4379 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL; 4380 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS; 4381 } 4382 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0) 4383 { 4384 hdr->sh_flags = 0; 4385 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS; 4386 } 4387 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0) 4388 { 4389 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0) 4390 { 4391 unsigned int adjust; 4392 4393 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign; 4394 if (adjust != 0) 4395 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust; 4396 } 4397 } 4398 } 4399 4400 return TRUE; 4401 } 4402 4403 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This 4404 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type. 4405 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI. 4406 4407 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure 4408 how to. */ 4409 4410 bfd_boolean 4411 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, 4412 const char *name) 4413 { 4414 flagword flags = 0; 4415 4416 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but 4417 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the 4418 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives 4419 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will 4420 probably get away with this. */ 4421 switch (hdr->sh_type) 4422 { 4423 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST: 4424 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0) 4425 return FALSE; 4426 break; 4427 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM: 4428 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0) 4429 return FALSE; 4430 break; 4431 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT: 4432 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0) 4433 return FALSE; 4434 break; 4435 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB: 4436 if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) != 0) 4437 return FALSE; 4438 break; 4439 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE: 4440 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0) 4441 return FALSE; 4442 break; 4443 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG: 4444 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0) 4445 return FALSE; 4446 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING; 4447 break; 4448 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO: 4449 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0 4450 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo)) 4451 return FALSE; 4452 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE); 4453 break; 4454 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE: 4455 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0) 4456 return FALSE; 4457 break; 4458 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT: 4459 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) != 0) 4460 return FALSE; 4461 break; 4462 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS: 4463 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) != 0) 4464 return FALSE; 4465 break; 4466 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF: 4467 if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) != 0) 4468 return FALSE; 4469 break; 4470 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB: 4471 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0) 4472 return FALSE; 4473 break; 4474 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS: 4475 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) != 0 4476 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel", 4477 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) != 0) 4478 return FALSE; 4479 break; 4480 default: 4481 return FALSE; 4482 } 4483 4484 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name)) 4485 return FALSE; 4486 4487 if (flags) 4488 { 4489 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, 4490 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, 4491 hdr->bfd_section) 4492 | flags))) 4493 return FALSE; 4494 } 4495 4496 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */ 4497 4498 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information 4499 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while 4500 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section 4501 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */ 4502 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO) 4503 { 4504 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext; 4505 Elf32_RegInfo s; 4506 4507 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, 4508 &ext, 0, sizeof ext)) 4509 return FALSE; 4510 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s); 4511 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value; 4512 } 4513 4514 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and 4515 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both 4516 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case, 4517 they should agree. */ 4518 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS) 4519 { 4520 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend; 4521 4522 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size); 4523 if (contents == NULL) 4524 return FALSE; 4525 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents, 4526 0, hdr->sh_size)) 4527 { 4528 free (contents); 4529 return FALSE; 4530 } 4531 l = contents; 4532 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size; 4533 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend) 4534 { 4535 Elf_Internal_Options intopt; 4536 4537 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l, 4538 &intopt); 4539 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO) 4540 { 4541 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg; 4542 4543 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in 4544 (abfd, 4545 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *) 4546 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))), 4547 &intreg); 4548 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value; 4549 } 4550 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO) 4551 { 4552 Elf32_RegInfo intreg; 4553 4554 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in 4555 (abfd, 4556 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *) 4557 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))), 4558 &intreg); 4559 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value; 4560 } 4561 l += intopt.size; 4562 } 4563 free (contents); 4564 } 4565 4566 return TRUE; 4567 } 4568 4569 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the 4570 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is 4571 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */ 4572 4573 bfd_boolean 4574 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec) 4575 { 4576 register const char *name; 4577 4578 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec); 4579 4580 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0) 4581 { 4582 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST; 4583 hdr->sh_info = sec->_raw_size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib); 4584 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */ 4585 } 4586 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0) 4587 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT; 4588 else if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0) 4589 { 4590 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB; 4591 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab); 4592 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */ 4593 } 4594 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0) 4595 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE; 4596 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0) 4597 { 4598 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG; 4599 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an 4600 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */ 4601 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0) 4602 hdr->sh_entsize = 0; 4603 else 4604 hdr->sh_entsize = 1; 4605 } 4606 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0) 4607 { 4608 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO; 4609 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an 4610 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */ 4611 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 4612 { 4613 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0) 4614 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo); 4615 else 4616 hdr->sh_entsize = 1; 4617 } 4618 else 4619 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo); 4620 } 4621 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) 4622 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0 4623 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0 4624 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0)) 4625 { 4626 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 4627 hdr->sh_entsize = 0; 4628 #if 0 4629 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */ 4630 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; 4631 #endif 4632 } 4633 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0 4634 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0 4635 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0 4636 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0 4637 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0 4638 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0) 4639 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL; 4640 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0) 4641 { 4642 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE; 4643 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP; 4644 } 4645 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", strlen (".MIPS.content")) == 0) 4646 { 4647 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT; 4648 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP; 4649 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */ 4650 } 4651 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0) 4652 { 4653 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS; 4654 hdr->sh_entsize = 1; 4655 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP; 4656 } 4657 else if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) == 0) 4658 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF; 4659 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0) 4660 { 4661 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB; 4662 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in 4663 final_write_processing. */ 4664 } 4665 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0 4666 || strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel", 4667 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0) 4668 { 4669 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS; 4670 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP; 4671 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */ 4672 } 4673 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0) 4674 { 4675 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM; 4676 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC; 4677 hdr->sh_entsize = 8; 4678 } 4679 4680 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default 4681 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the 4682 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use 4683 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections. 4684 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */ 4685 4686 return TRUE; 4687 } 4688 4689 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section 4690 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. 4691 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these, 4692 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least 4693 the .scommon section. */ 4694 4695 bfd_boolean 4696 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 4697 asection *sec, int *retval) 4698 { 4699 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0) 4700 { 4701 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON; 4702 return TRUE; 4703 } 4704 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0) 4705 { 4706 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON; 4707 return TRUE; 4708 } 4709 return FALSE; 4710 } 4711 4712 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object 4713 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */ 4714 4715 bfd_boolean 4716 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 4717 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep, 4718 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 4719 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp) 4720 { 4721 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) 4722 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0 4723 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0) 4724 { 4725 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */ 4726 *namep = NULL; 4727 return TRUE; 4728 } 4729 4730 switch (sym->st_shndx) 4731 { 4732 case SHN_COMMON: 4733 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically 4734 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */ 4735 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd) 4736 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6) 4737 break; 4738 /* Fall through. */ 4739 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON: 4740 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon"); 4741 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON; 4742 *valp = sym->st_size; 4743 break; 4744 4745 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT: 4746 /* This section is used in a shared object. */ 4747 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL) 4748 { 4749 asymbol *elf_text_symbol; 4750 asection *elf_text_section; 4751 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection); 4752 4753 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 4754 if (elf_text_section == NULL) 4755 return FALSE; 4756 4757 amt = sizeof (asymbol); 4758 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 4759 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL) 4760 return FALSE; 4761 4762 /* Initialize the section. */ 4763 4764 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section; 4765 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol; 4766 4767 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol; 4768 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol; 4769 4770 elf_text_section->name = ".text"; 4771 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS; 4772 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL; 4773 elf_text_section->owner = abfd; 4774 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text"; 4775 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC; 4776 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section; 4777 } 4778 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if 4779 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense, 4780 so I took it out. */ 4781 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section; 4782 break; 4783 4784 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON: 4785 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */ 4786 case SHN_MIPS_DATA: 4787 /* This section is used in a shared object. */ 4788 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL) 4789 { 4790 asymbol *elf_data_symbol; 4791 asection *elf_data_section; 4792 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection); 4793 4794 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 4795 if (elf_data_section == NULL) 4796 return FALSE; 4797 4798 amt = sizeof (asymbol); 4799 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 4800 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL) 4801 return FALSE; 4802 4803 /* Initialize the section. */ 4804 4805 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section; 4806 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol; 4807 4808 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol; 4809 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol; 4810 4811 elf_data_section->name = ".data"; 4812 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS; 4813 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL; 4814 elf_data_section->owner = abfd; 4815 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data"; 4816 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC; 4817 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section; 4818 } 4819 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if 4820 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense, 4821 so I took it out. */ 4822 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section; 4823 break; 4824 4825 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED: 4826 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr; 4827 break; 4828 } 4829 4830 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) 4831 && ! info->shared 4832 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec 4833 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0) 4834 { 4835 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 4836 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh; 4837 4838 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */ 4839 bh = NULL; 4840 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol 4841 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE, 4842 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh))) 4843 return FALSE; 4844 4845 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh; 4846 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF; 4847 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR; 4848 h->type = STT_OBJECT; 4849 4850 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 4851 return FALSE; 4852 4853 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE; 4854 } 4855 4856 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it 4857 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with 4858 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */ 4859 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16) 4860 ++*valp; 4861 4862 return TRUE; 4863 } 4864 4865 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global 4866 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is 4867 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */ 4868 4869 bfd_boolean 4870 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook 4871 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 4872 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, 4873 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 4874 { 4875 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then 4876 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small 4877 common in the output file. */ 4878 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON 4879 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0) 4880 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON; 4881 4882 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16 4883 && (sym->st_value & 1) != 0) 4884 --sym->st_value; 4885 4886 return TRUE; 4887 } 4888 4889 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */ 4890 4891 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */ 4892 4893 bfd_boolean 4894 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 4895 { 4896 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 4897 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh; 4898 flagword flags; 4899 register asection *s; 4900 const char * const *namep; 4901 4902 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY 4903 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY); 4904 4905 /* Mips ABI requests the .dynamic section to be read only. */ 4906 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"); 4907 if (s != NULL) 4908 { 4909 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags)) 4910 return FALSE; 4911 } 4912 4913 /* We need to create .got section. */ 4914 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE)) 4915 return FALSE; 4916 4917 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, TRUE)) 4918 return FALSE; 4919 4920 /* Create .stub section. */ 4921 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, 4922 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL) 4923 { 4924 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)); 4925 if (s == NULL 4926 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags | SEC_CODE) 4927 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4928 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd))) 4929 return FALSE; 4930 } 4931 4932 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none) 4933 && !info->shared 4934 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL) 4935 { 4936 s = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rld_map"); 4937 if (s == NULL 4938 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY) 4939 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4940 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd))) 4941 return FALSE; 4942 } 4943 4944 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the 4945 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation 4946 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that 4947 the linker takes such action. */ 4948 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5) 4949 { 4950 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++) 4951 { 4952 bh = NULL; 4953 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol 4954 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0, 4955 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh))) 4956 return FALSE; 4957 4958 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh; 4959 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF; 4960 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR; 4961 h->type = STT_SECTION; 4962 4963 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 4964 return FALSE; 4965 } 4966 4967 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */ 4968 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 4969 { 4970 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info)) 4971 return FALSE; 4972 } 4973 4974 /* Change alignments of some sections. */ 4975 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash"); 4976 if (s != NULL) 4977 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)); 4978 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym"); 4979 if (s != NULL) 4980 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)); 4981 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr"); 4982 if (s != NULL) 4983 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)); 4984 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo"); 4985 if (s != NULL) 4986 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)); 4987 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"); 4988 if (s != NULL) 4989 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)); 4990 } 4991 4992 if (!info->shared) 4993 { 4994 const char *name; 4995 4996 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING"; 4997 bh = NULL; 4998 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol 4999 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0, 5000 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh))) 5001 return FALSE; 5002 5003 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh; 5004 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF; 5005 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR; 5006 h->type = STT_SECTION; 5007 5008 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 5009 return FALSE; 5010 5011 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head) 5012 { 5013 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section 5014 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to 5015 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in 5016 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */ 5017 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map"); 5018 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 5019 5020 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP"; 5021 bh = NULL; 5022 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol 5023 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE, 5024 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh))) 5025 return FALSE; 5026 5027 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh; 5028 h->elf_link_hash_flags &= ~ELF_LINK_NON_ELF; 5029 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR; 5030 h->type = STT_OBJECT; 5031 5032 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h)) 5033 return FALSE; 5034 } 5035 } 5036 5037 return TRUE; 5038 } 5039 5040 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and 5041 allocate space in the global offset table. */ 5042 5043 bfd_boolean 5044 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 5045 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs) 5046 { 5047 const char *name; 5048 bfd *dynobj; 5049 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 5050 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 5051 struct mips_got_info *g; 5052 size_t extsymoff; 5053 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel; 5054 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end; 5055 asection *sgot; 5056 asection *sreloc; 5057 const struct elf_backend_data *bed; 5058 5059 if (info->relocatable) 5060 return TRUE; 5061 5062 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 5063 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr; 5064 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd); 5065 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info; 5066 5067 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */ 5068 5069 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec); 5070 if (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0) 5071 { 5072 unsigned long r_symndx; 5073 5074 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol 5075 this is for. */ 5076 5077 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info); 5078 5079 if (r_symndx < extsymoff 5080 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL) 5081 { 5082 asection *o; 5083 5084 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be 5085 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other 5086 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */ 5087 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next) 5088 { 5089 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs; 5090 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend; 5091 5092 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */ 5093 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0 5094 || o->reloc_count == 0 5095 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), FN_STUB, 5096 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0 5097 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_STUB, 5098 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0 5099 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_FP_STUB, 5100 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0) 5101 continue; 5102 5103 sec_relocs 5104 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL, 5105 info->keep_memory); 5106 if (sec_relocs == NULL) 5107 return FALSE; 5108 5109 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count; 5110 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++) 5111 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx 5112 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26) 5113 break; 5114 5115 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs) 5116 free (sec_relocs); 5117 5118 if (r < rend) 5119 break; 5120 } 5121 5122 if (o == NULL) 5123 { 5124 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do 5125 not need it. Since this function is called before 5126 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we 5127 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE 5128 flag. */ 5129 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 5130 return TRUE; 5131 } 5132 5133 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for 5134 this BFD. */ 5135 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL) 5136 { 5137 unsigned long symcount; 5138 asection **n; 5139 bfd_size_type amt; 5140 5141 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) 5142 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr); 5143 else 5144 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info; 5145 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *); 5146 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 5147 if (n == NULL) 5148 return FALSE; 5149 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n; 5150 } 5151 5152 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec; 5153 5154 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case. 5155 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through 5156 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set 5157 it here, because we just have a local stub. */ 5158 } 5159 else 5160 { 5161 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 5162 5163 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 5164 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]); 5165 5166 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */ 5167 5168 h->fn_stub = sec; 5169 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE; 5170 } 5171 } 5172 else if (strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0 5173 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0) 5174 { 5175 unsigned long r_symndx; 5176 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 5177 asection **loc; 5178 5179 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol 5180 this is for. */ 5181 5182 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info); 5183 5184 if (r_symndx < extsymoff 5185 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL) 5186 { 5187 /* This stub was actually built for a static symbol defined 5188 in the same file. We assume that all static symbols in 5189 mips16 code are themselves mips16, so we can simply 5190 discard this stub. Since this function is called before 5191 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we can 5192 easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */ 5193 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 5194 return TRUE; 5195 } 5196 5197 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 5198 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]); 5199 5200 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */ 5201 5202 if (strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0) 5203 loc = &h->call_fp_stub; 5204 else 5205 loc = &h->call_stub; 5206 5207 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we 5208 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since 5209 this function is called before the linker maps input sections 5210 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the 5211 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. We can also discard this section if we 5212 happen to already know that this is a mips16 function; it is 5213 not necessary to check this here, as it is checked later, but 5214 it is slightly faster to check now. */ 5215 if (*loc != NULL || h->root.other == STO_MIPS16) 5216 { 5217 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE; 5218 return TRUE; 5219 } 5220 5221 *loc = sec; 5222 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE; 5223 } 5224 5225 if (dynobj == NULL) 5226 { 5227 sgot = NULL; 5228 g = NULL; 5229 } 5230 else 5231 { 5232 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE); 5233 if (sgot == NULL) 5234 g = NULL; 5235 else 5236 { 5237 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL); 5238 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info; 5239 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 5240 } 5241 } 5242 5243 sreloc = NULL; 5244 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd); 5245 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel; 5246 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel) 5247 { 5248 unsigned long r_symndx; 5249 unsigned int r_type; 5250 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 5251 5252 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info); 5253 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info); 5254 5255 if (r_symndx < extsymoff) 5256 h = NULL; 5257 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr)) 5258 { 5259 (*_bfd_error_handler) 5260 (_("%s: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"), 5261 bfd_archive_filename (abfd), name); 5262 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 5263 return FALSE; 5264 } 5265 else 5266 { 5267 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]; 5268 5269 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */ 5270 if (h != NULL) 5271 { 5272 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect) 5273 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link; 5274 } 5275 } 5276 5277 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */ 5278 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL) 5279 { 5280 switch (r_type) 5281 { 5282 case R_MIPS_GOT16: 5283 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 5284 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 5285 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 5286 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16: 5287 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16: 5288 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE: 5289 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST: 5290 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP: 5291 if (dynobj == NULL) 5292 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd; 5293 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE)) 5294 return FALSE; 5295 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot); 5296 break; 5297 5298 case R_MIPS_32: 5299 case R_MIPS_REL32: 5300 case R_MIPS_64: 5301 if (dynobj == NULL 5302 && (info->shared || h != NULL) 5303 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 5304 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd; 5305 break; 5306 5307 default: 5308 break; 5309 } 5310 } 5311 5312 if (!h && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16 5313 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 5314 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP)) 5315 { 5316 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We 5317 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the 5318 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of 5319 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and 5320 R_MIPS_CALL16. We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or 5321 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an 5322 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */ 5323 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx, 5324 rel->r_addend, g)) 5325 return FALSE; 5326 } 5327 5328 switch (r_type) 5329 { 5330 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 5331 if (h == NULL) 5332 { 5333 (*_bfd_error_handler) 5334 (_("%s: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"), 5335 bfd_archive_filename (abfd), (unsigned long) rel->r_offset); 5336 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 5337 return FALSE; 5338 } 5339 /* Fall through. */ 5340 5341 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 5342 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 5343 if (h != NULL) 5344 { 5345 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */ 5346 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g)) 5347 return FALSE; 5348 5349 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined 5350 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See 5351 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */ 5352 h->elf_link_hash_flags |= ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT; 5353 h->type = STT_FUNC; 5354 } 5355 break; 5356 5357 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE: 5358 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will 5359 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */ 5360 if (h == NULL) 5361 break; 5362 else 5363 { 5364 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips = 5365 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5366 5367 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 5368 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 5369 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 5370 hmips->root.root.u.i.link; 5371 5372 if ((hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) 5373 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic 5374 && ! (hmips->root.elf_link_hash_flags 5375 & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL))) 5376 break; 5377 } 5378 /* Fall through. */ 5379 5380 case R_MIPS_GOT16: 5381 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16: 5382 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16: 5383 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP: 5384 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */ 5385 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g)) 5386 return FALSE; 5387 break; 5388 5389 case R_MIPS_32: 5390 case R_MIPS_REL32: 5391 case R_MIPS_64: 5392 if ((info->shared || h != NULL) 5393 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 5394 { 5395 if (sreloc == NULL) 5396 { 5397 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, TRUE); 5398 if (sreloc == NULL) 5399 return FALSE; 5400 } 5401 #define MIPS_READONLY_SECTION (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY) 5402 if (info->shared) 5403 { 5404 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these 5405 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32 5406 relocs. We make room for this reloc in the 5407 .rel.dyn reloc section. */ 5408 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 1); 5409 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION) 5410 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION) 5411 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are 5412 relocations against the text segment. */ 5413 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL; 5414 } 5415 else 5416 { 5417 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips; 5418 5419 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is 5420 defined in a dynamic object. */ 5421 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5422 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs; 5423 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION) 5424 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION) 5425 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there 5426 are relocations against the text segment. */ 5427 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE; 5428 } 5429 5430 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for 5431 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol 5432 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are 5433 dynamic relocations against it. */ 5434 if (h != NULL) 5435 { 5436 if (dynobj == NULL) 5437 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd; 5438 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE)) 5439 return FALSE; 5440 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot); 5441 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g)) 5442 return FALSE; 5443 } 5444 } 5445 5446 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 5447 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size += 5448 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo); 5449 break; 5450 5451 case R_MIPS_26: 5452 case R_MIPS_GPREL16: 5453 case R_MIPS_LITERAL: 5454 case R_MIPS_GPREL32: 5455 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 5456 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size += 5457 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo); 5458 break; 5459 5460 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy. 5461 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */ 5462 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT: 5463 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset)) 5464 return FALSE; 5465 break; 5466 5467 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually 5468 used. Record for later use during GC. */ 5469 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY: 5470 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset)) 5471 return FALSE; 5472 break; 5473 5474 default: 5475 break; 5476 } 5477 5478 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations 5479 related to taking the function's address. */ 5480 switch (r_type) 5481 { 5482 default: 5483 if (h != NULL) 5484 { 5485 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh; 5486 5487 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5488 mh->no_fn_stub = TRUE; 5489 } 5490 break; 5491 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 5492 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 5493 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 5494 case R_MIPS_JALR: 5495 break; 5496 } 5497 5498 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global 5499 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one. 5500 References from a stub section do not count. */ 5501 if (h != NULL 5502 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26 5503 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), FN_STUB, 5504 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) != 0 5505 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_STUB, 5506 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) != 0 5507 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_FP_STUB, 5508 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) != 0) 5509 { 5510 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh; 5511 5512 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5513 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE; 5514 } 5515 } 5516 5517 return TRUE; 5518 } 5519 5520 bfd_boolean 5521 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, 5522 struct bfd_link_info *link_info, 5523 bfd_boolean *again) 5524 { 5525 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs; 5526 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend; 5527 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 5528 bfd_byte *contents = NULL; 5529 bfd_byte *free_contents = NULL; 5530 size_t extsymoff; 5531 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE; 5532 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset; 5533 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL; 5534 5535 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */ 5536 *again = FALSE; 5537 5538 if (link_info->relocatable) 5539 return TRUE; 5540 5541 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL, 5542 link_info->keep_memory); 5543 if (internal_relocs == NULL) 5544 return TRUE; 5545 5546 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count 5547 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel; 5548 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr; 5549 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info; 5550 5551 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++) 5552 { 5553 bfd_vma symval; 5554 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset; 5555 unsigned int r_type; 5556 unsigned long r_symndx; 5557 asection *sym_sec; 5558 unsigned long instruction; 5559 5560 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked 5561 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to. 5562 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */ 5563 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info); 5564 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR) 5565 continue; 5566 5567 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info); 5568 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */ 5569 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff) 5570 { 5571 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h 5572 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) 5573 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]); 5574 5575 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect 5576 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning) 5577 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link; 5578 5579 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden, 5580 skip it. */ 5581 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 5582 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak) 5583 && h->root.root.u.def.section) 5584 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic 5585 && ! (h->root.elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL))) 5586 continue; 5587 5588 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section; 5589 if (sym_sec->output_section) 5590 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value 5591 + sym_sec->output_section->vma 5592 + sym_sec->output_offset); 5593 else 5594 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value; 5595 } 5596 else 5597 { 5598 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym; 5599 5600 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */ 5601 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0) 5602 { 5603 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents; 5604 if (isymbuf == NULL) 5605 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 5606 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0, 5607 NULL, NULL, NULL); 5608 if (isymbuf == NULL) 5609 goto relax_return; 5610 } 5611 5612 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx; 5613 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF) 5614 continue; 5615 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS) 5616 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr; 5617 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON) 5618 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr; 5619 else 5620 sym_sec 5621 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx); 5622 symval = isym->st_value 5623 + sym_sec->output_section->vma 5624 + sym_sec->output_offset; 5625 } 5626 5627 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the 5628 branch target. */ 5629 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend) 5630 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4); 5631 5632 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */ 5633 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0) 5634 continue; 5635 5636 sym_offset >>= 2; 5637 5638 /* Check that it's in range. */ 5639 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000) 5640 continue; 5641 5642 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */ 5643 if (contents == NULL) 5644 { 5645 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */ 5646 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL) 5647 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents; 5648 else 5649 { 5650 contents = bfd_malloc (sec->_raw_size); 5651 if (contents == NULL) 5652 goto relax_return; 5653 5654 free_contents = contents; 5655 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, contents, 5656 0, sec->_raw_size)) 5657 goto relax_return; 5658 } 5659 } 5660 5661 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset); 5662 5663 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */ 5664 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809) 5665 instruction = 0x04110000; 5666 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */ 5667 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008) 5668 instruction = 0x10000000; 5669 else 5670 continue; 5671 5672 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff); 5673 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset); 5674 changed_contents = TRUE; 5675 } 5676 5677 if (contents != NULL 5678 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents) 5679 { 5680 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory) 5681 free (contents); 5682 else 5683 { 5684 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */ 5685 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents; 5686 } 5687 } 5688 return TRUE; 5689 5690 relax_return: 5691 if (free_contents != NULL) 5692 free (free_contents); 5693 return FALSE; 5694 } 5695 5696 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a 5697 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the 5698 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to 5699 change the definition to something the rest of the link can 5700 understand. */ 5701 5702 bfd_boolean 5703 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, 5704 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h) 5705 { 5706 bfd *dynobj; 5707 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips; 5708 asection *s; 5709 5710 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 5711 5712 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */ 5713 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL 5714 && ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) 5715 || h->weakdef != NULL 5716 || ((h->elf_link_hash_flags 5717 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0 5718 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags 5719 & ELF_LINK_HASH_REF_REGULAR) != 0 5720 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags 5721 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))); 5722 5723 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy 5724 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output 5725 file. */ 5726 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h; 5727 if (! info->relocatable 5728 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0 5729 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak 5730 || (h->elf_link_hash_flags 5731 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0)) 5732 { 5733 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 5734 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs); 5735 if (hmips->readonly_reloc) 5736 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations 5737 against the text segment. */ 5738 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL; 5739 } 5740 5741 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */ 5742 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub 5743 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) != 0) 5744 { 5745 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 5746 return TRUE; 5747 5748 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set 5749 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make 5750 function pointers compare as equal between the normal 5751 executable and the shared library. */ 5752 if ((h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0) 5753 { 5754 /* We need .stub section. */ 5755 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, 5756 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)); 5757 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 5758 5759 h->root.u.def.section = s; 5760 h->root.u.def.value = s->_raw_size; 5761 5762 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */ 5763 h->plt.offset = s->_raw_size; 5764 5765 /* Make room for this stub code. */ 5766 s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE; 5767 5768 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index 5769 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */ 5770 return TRUE; 5771 } 5772 } 5773 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC) 5774 && (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_HASH_NEEDS_PLT) == 0) 5775 { 5776 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and 5777 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */ 5778 h->root.u.def.value = 0; 5779 return TRUE; 5780 } 5781 5782 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the 5783 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the 5784 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */ 5785 if (h->weakdef != NULL) 5786 { 5787 BFD_ASSERT (h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined 5788 || h->weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak); 5789 h->root.u.def.section = h->weakdef->root.u.def.section; 5790 h->root.u.def.value = h->weakdef->root.u.def.value; 5791 return TRUE; 5792 } 5793 5794 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which 5795 is not a function. */ 5796 5797 return TRUE; 5798 } 5799 5800 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read, 5801 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We 5802 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */ 5803 5804 bfd_boolean 5805 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd, 5806 struct bfd_link_info *info) 5807 { 5808 asection *ri; 5809 5810 bfd *dynobj; 5811 asection *s; 5812 struct mips_got_info *g; 5813 int i; 5814 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0; 5815 bfd_size_type local_gotno; 5816 bfd *sub; 5817 5818 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */ 5819 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo"); 5820 if (ri != NULL) 5821 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo)); 5822 5823 if (! (info->relocatable 5824 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen)) 5825 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info), 5826 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL); 5827 5828 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 5829 if (dynobj == NULL) 5830 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */ 5831 return TRUE; 5832 5833 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s); 5834 if (s == NULL) 5835 return TRUE; 5836 5837 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That 5838 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries 5839 required. */ 5840 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next) 5841 { 5842 asection *subsection; 5843 5844 for (subsection = sub->sections; 5845 subsection; 5846 subsection = subsection->next) 5847 { 5848 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0) 5849 continue; 5850 loadable_size += ((subsection->_raw_size + 0xf) 5851 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf); 5852 } 5853 } 5854 5855 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with 5856 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or 5857 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols 5858 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We 5859 do that here. */ 5860 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1)) 5861 return FALSE; 5862 5863 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL) 5864 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx; 5865 else 5866 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring 5867 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */ 5868 i = 0; 5869 5870 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus 5871 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX 5872 rld. */ 5873 loadable_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE * (i + 1); 5874 5875 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of 5876 contiguous sections. Is 5 enough? */ 5877 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5; 5878 5879 g->local_gotno += local_gotno; 5880 s->_raw_size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd); 5881 5882 g->global_gotno = i; 5883 s->_raw_size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd); 5884 5885 if (s->_raw_size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (output_bfd) 5886 && ! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno)) 5887 return FALSE; 5888 5889 return TRUE; 5890 } 5891 5892 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */ 5893 5894 bfd_boolean 5895 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd, 5896 struct bfd_link_info *info) 5897 { 5898 bfd *dynobj; 5899 asection *s; 5900 bfd_boolean reltext; 5901 5902 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 5903 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL); 5904 5905 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 5906 { 5907 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */ 5908 if (info->executable && !info->static_link) 5909 { 5910 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp"); 5911 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 5912 s->_raw_size 5913 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1; 5914 s->contents 5915 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd); 5916 } 5917 } 5918 5919 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have 5920 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate 5921 memory for them. */ 5922 reltext = FALSE; 5923 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 5924 { 5925 const char *name; 5926 bfd_boolean strip; 5927 5928 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none 5929 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */ 5930 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s); 5931 5932 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0) 5933 continue; 5934 5935 strip = FALSE; 5936 5937 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) == 0) 5938 { 5939 if (s->_raw_size == 0) 5940 { 5941 /* We only strip the section if the output section name 5942 has the same name. Otherwise, there might be several 5943 input sections for this output section. FIXME: This 5944 code is probably not needed these days anyhow, since 5945 the linker now does not create empty output sections. */ 5946 if (s->output_section != NULL 5947 && strcmp (name, 5948 bfd_get_section_name (s->output_section->owner, 5949 s->output_section)) == 0) 5950 strip = TRUE; 5951 } 5952 else 5953 { 5954 const char *outname; 5955 asection *target; 5956 5957 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only 5958 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry. 5959 If the relocation section is .rel.dyn, we always 5960 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether 5961 there exists a relocation to a read only section or 5962 not. */ 5963 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, 5964 s->output_section); 5965 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4); 5966 if ((target != NULL 5967 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0 5968 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) 5969 || strcmp (outname, ".rel.dyn") == 0) 5970 reltext = TRUE; 5971 5972 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need 5973 to copy relocs into the output file. */ 5974 if (strcmp (name, ".rel.dyn") != 0) 5975 s->reloc_count = 0; 5976 5977 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will 5978 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do, 5979 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it 5980 will move them around between input sections' 5981 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be 5982 broken, so don't let it run. */ 5983 info->combreloc = 0; 5984 } 5985 } 5986 else if (strncmp (name, ".got", 4) == 0) 5987 { 5988 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done 5989 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped 5990 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries 5991 hash tables. */ 5992 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL); 5993 struct mips_got_info *g = gg; 5994 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg; 5995 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0; 5996 5997 if (gg->next) 5998 { 5999 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd); 6000 set_got_offset_arg.info = info; 6001 6002 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg); 6003 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next) 6004 { 6005 unsigned int save_assign; 6006 6007 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g); 6008 6009 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */ 6010 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno; 6011 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno; 6012 set_got_offset_arg.g = g; 6013 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0; 6014 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, 6015 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset, 6016 &set_got_offset_arg); 6017 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs; 6018 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno 6019 <= g->global_gotno); 6020 6021 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign; 6022 if (info->shared) 6023 { 6024 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno; 6025 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno 6026 + g->next->global_gotno 6027 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO); 6028 } 6029 } 6030 6031 if (needed_relocs) 6032 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, needed_relocs); 6033 } 6034 } 6035 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0) 6036 { 6037 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end 6038 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */ 6039 s->_raw_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE; 6040 } 6041 else if (! info->shared 6042 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head 6043 && strncmp (name, ".rld_map", 8) == 0) 6044 { 6045 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the 6046 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */ 6047 s->_raw_size += 4; 6048 } 6049 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) 6050 && strncmp (name, ".compact_rel", 12) == 0) 6051 s->_raw_size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size; 6052 else if (strncmp (name, ".init", 5) != 0) 6053 { 6054 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */ 6055 continue; 6056 } 6057 6058 if (strip) 6059 { 6060 _bfd_strip_section_from_output (info, s); 6061 continue; 6062 } 6063 6064 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */ 6065 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->_raw_size); 6066 if (s->contents == NULL && s->_raw_size != 0) 6067 { 6068 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory); 6069 return FALSE; 6070 } 6071 } 6072 6073 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 6074 { 6075 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the 6076 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we 6077 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for 6078 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the 6079 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */ 6080 if (! info->shared) 6081 { 6082 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the 6083 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. */ 6084 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0)) 6085 return FALSE; 6086 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 6087 { 6088 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0)) 6089 return FALSE; 6090 } 6091 } 6092 else 6093 { 6094 /* Shared libraries on traditional mips have DT_DEBUG. */ 6095 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 6096 { 6097 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0)) 6098 return FALSE; 6099 } 6100 } 6101 6102 if (reltext && SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 6103 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL; 6104 6105 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0) 6106 { 6107 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0)) 6108 return FALSE; 6109 } 6110 6111 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0)) 6112 return FALSE; 6113 6114 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE)) 6115 { 6116 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0)) 6117 return FALSE; 6118 6119 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0)) 6120 return FALSE; 6121 6122 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0)) 6123 return FALSE; 6124 } 6125 6126 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0)) 6127 return FALSE; 6128 6129 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0)) 6130 return FALSE; 6131 6132 #if 0 6133 /* Time stamps in executable files are a bad idea. */ 6134 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP, 0)) 6135 return FALSE; 6136 #endif 6137 6138 #if 0 /* FIXME */ 6139 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM, 0)) 6140 return FALSE; 6141 #endif 6142 6143 #if 0 /* FIXME */ 6144 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_IVERSION, 0)) 6145 return FALSE; 6146 #endif 6147 6148 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0)) 6149 return FALSE; 6150 6151 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0)) 6152 return FALSE; 6153 6154 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0)) 6155 return FALSE; 6156 6157 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0)) 6158 return FALSE; 6159 6160 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0)) 6161 return FALSE; 6162 6163 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5 6164 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0)) 6165 return FALSE; 6166 6167 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6 6168 && (bfd_get_section_by_name 6169 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj))) 6170 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0)) 6171 return FALSE; 6172 } 6173 6174 return TRUE; 6175 } 6176 6177 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */ 6178 6179 bfd_boolean 6180 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, 6181 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section, 6182 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs, 6183 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms, 6184 asection **local_sections) 6185 { 6186 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel; 6187 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend; 6188 bfd_vma addend = 0; 6189 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE; 6190 const struct elf_backend_data *bed; 6191 6192 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd); 6193 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel; 6194 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel) 6195 { 6196 const char *name; 6197 bfd_vma value; 6198 reloc_howto_type *howto; 6199 bfd_boolean require_jalx; 6200 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a 6201 REL relocation. */ 6202 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE; 6203 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info); 6204 const char *msg; 6205 6206 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */ 6207 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd)) 6208 { 6209 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use 6210 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the 6211 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address 6212 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is 6213 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the 6214 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */ 6215 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE); 6216 6217 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position 6218 of the reloc. */ 6219 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd)) 6220 rel->r_offset += 4; 6221 } 6222 else 6223 /* NewABI defaults to RELA relocations. */ 6224 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, 6225 NEWABI_P (input_bfd) 6226 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P 6227 (input_bfd, input_section, 6228 rel - relocs))); 6229 6230 if (!use_saved_addend_p) 6231 { 6232 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr; 6233 6234 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety, 6235 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be 6236 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the 6237 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation 6238 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's 6239 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */ 6240 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr; 6241 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs) 6242 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)) 6243 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2; 6244 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd)) 6245 { 6246 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */ 6247 rela_relocation_p = FALSE; 6248 6249 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */ 6250 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd, 6251 contents); 6252 addend &= howto->src_mask; 6253 6254 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a 6255 combination of the addend stored in two different 6256 relocations. */ 6257 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 6258 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16 6259 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 6260 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, 6261 local_sections, FALSE))) 6262 { 6263 bfd_vma l; 6264 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation; 6265 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto; 6266 unsigned int lo; 6267 6268 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, 6269 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16 6270 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does 6271 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of 6272 the LO16 value.) 6273 6274 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation. */ 6275 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16) 6276 lo = R_MIPS_GNU_REL_LO16; 6277 else 6278 lo = R_MIPS_LO16; 6279 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd, lo, 6280 rel, relend); 6281 if (lo16_relocation == NULL) 6282 return FALSE; 6283 6284 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */ 6285 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, lo, FALSE); 6286 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto, lo16_relocation, 6287 input_bfd, contents); 6288 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask; 6289 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift; 6290 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16); 6291 6292 addend <<= 16; 6293 6294 /* Compute the combined addend. */ 6295 addend += l; 6296 6297 /* If PC-relative, subtract the difference between the 6298 address of the LO part of the reloc and the address of 6299 the HI part. The relocation is relative to the LO 6300 part, but mips_elf_calculate_relocation() doesn't 6301 know its address or the difference from the HI part, so 6302 we subtract that difference here. See also the 6303 comment in mips_elf_calculate_relocation(). */ 6304 if (r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16) 6305 addend -= (lo16_relocation->r_offset - rel->r_offset); 6306 } 6307 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL) 6308 { 6309 /* The addend is scrambled in the object file. See 6310 mips_elf_perform_relocation for details on the 6311 format. */ 6312 addend = (((addend & 0x1f0000) >> 5) 6313 | ((addend & 0x7e00000) >> 16) 6314 | (addend & 0x1f)); 6315 } 6316 else 6317 addend <<= howto->rightshift; 6318 } 6319 else 6320 addend = rel->r_addend; 6321 } 6322 6323 if (info->relocatable) 6324 { 6325 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym; 6326 unsigned long r_symndx; 6327 6328 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd) 6329 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd)) 6330 rel->r_offset -= 4; 6331 6332 /* Since we're just relocating, all we need to do is copy 6333 the relocations back out to the object file, unless 6334 they're against a section symbol, in which case we need 6335 to adjust by the section offset, or unless they're GP 6336 relative in which case we need to adjust by the amount 6337 that we're adjusting GP in this relocatable object. */ 6338 6339 if (! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, 6340 FALSE)) 6341 /* There's nothing to do for non-local relocations. */ 6342 continue; 6343 6344 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL 6345 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16 6346 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32 6347 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL) 6348 addend -= (_bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd) 6349 - _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd)); 6350 6351 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info); 6352 sym = local_syms + r_symndx; 6353 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION) 6354 /* Adjust the addend appropriately. */ 6355 addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset; 6356 6357 if (rela_relocation_p) 6358 /* If this is a RELA relocation, just update the addend. */ 6359 rel->r_addend = addend; 6360 else 6361 { 6362 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 6363 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 6364 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL_HI16) 6365 addend = mips_elf_high (addend); 6366 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER) 6367 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend); 6368 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST) 6369 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend); 6370 else 6371 addend >>= howto->rightshift; 6372 6373 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination 6374 mask because the place to which we are writing will be 6375 source of the addend in the final link. */ 6376 addend &= howto->src_mask; 6377 6378 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)) 6379 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit 6380 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be 6381 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc 6382 but for endianness. */ 6383 { 6384 bfd_vma sign_bits; 6385 bfd_vma low_bits; 6386 bfd_vma high_bits; 6387 6388 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) 6389 #ifdef BFD64 6390 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1; 6391 #else 6392 sign_bits = -1; 6393 #endif 6394 else 6395 sign_bits = 0; 6396 6397 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type, 6398 do two separate stores. */ 6399 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd)) 6400 { 6401 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant) 6402 first. */ 6403 low_bits = sign_bits; 6404 high_bits = addend; 6405 } 6406 else 6407 { 6408 low_bits = addend; 6409 high_bits = sign_bits; 6410 } 6411 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits, 6412 contents + rel->r_offset); 6413 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits, 6414 contents + rel->r_offset + 4); 6415 continue; 6416 } 6417 6418 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend, 6419 input_bfd, input_section, 6420 contents, FALSE)) 6421 return FALSE; 6422 } 6423 6424 /* Go on to the next relocation. */ 6425 continue; 6426 } 6427 6428 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive 6429 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are 6430 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend 6431 for the next. */ 6432 if (rel + 1 < relend 6433 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset 6434 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE) 6435 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE; 6436 else 6437 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE; 6438 6439 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */ 6440 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd, 6441 input_section, info, rel, 6442 addend, howto, local_syms, 6443 local_sections, &value, 6444 &name, &require_jalx, 6445 use_saved_addend_p)) 6446 { 6447 case bfd_reloc_continue: 6448 /* There's nothing to do. */ 6449 continue; 6450 6451 case bfd_reloc_undefined: 6452 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the 6453 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in 6454 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we 6455 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */ 6456 continue; 6457 6458 case bfd_reloc_notsupported: 6459 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error"); 6460 info->callbacks->warning 6461 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset); 6462 return FALSE; 6463 6464 case bfd_reloc_overflow: 6465 if (use_saved_addend_p) 6466 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for 6467 a given location. */ 6468 ; 6469 else 6470 { 6471 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL); 6472 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow) 6473 (info, name, howto->name, 0, 6474 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset))) 6475 return FALSE; 6476 } 6477 break; 6478 6479 case bfd_reloc_ok: 6480 break; 6481 6482 default: 6483 abort (); 6484 break; 6485 } 6486 6487 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going 6488 until we reach the last one. */ 6489 if (use_saved_addend_p) 6490 { 6491 addend = value; 6492 continue; 6493 } 6494 6495 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)) 6496 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit 6497 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32; 6498 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we 6499 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a 6500 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we 6501 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with 6502 only a 32-bit VMA. */ 6503 { 6504 bfd_vma sign_bits; 6505 bfd_vma low_bits; 6506 bfd_vma high_bits; 6507 6508 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31)) 6509 #ifdef BFD64 6510 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1; 6511 #else 6512 sign_bits = -1; 6513 #endif 6514 else 6515 sign_bits = 0; 6516 6517 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type, 6518 do two separate stores. */ 6519 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd)) 6520 { 6521 /* Undo what we did above. */ 6522 rel->r_offset -= 4; 6523 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant) 6524 first. */ 6525 low_bits = sign_bits; 6526 high_bits = value; 6527 } 6528 else 6529 { 6530 low_bits = value; 6531 high_bits = sign_bits; 6532 } 6533 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits, 6534 contents + rel->r_offset); 6535 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits, 6536 contents + rel->r_offset + 4); 6537 continue; 6538 } 6539 6540 /* Actually perform the relocation. */ 6541 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value, 6542 input_bfd, input_section, 6543 contents, require_jalx)) 6544 return FALSE; 6545 } 6546 6547 return TRUE; 6548 } 6549 6550 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker, 6551 adjust it appropriately now. */ 6552 6553 static void 6554 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 6555 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym) 6556 { 6557 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for 6558 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */ 6559 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = { 6560 "_ftext", 6561 "_etext", 6562 "__dso_displacement", 6563 "__elf_header", 6564 "__program_header_table", 6565 NULL 6566 }; 6567 6568 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = { 6569 "_fdata", 6570 "_edata", 6571 "_end", 6572 "_fbss", 6573 NULL 6574 }; 6575 6576 const char* const *p; 6577 int i; 6578 6579 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i) 6580 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols; 6581 *p; 6582 ++p) 6583 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0) 6584 { 6585 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the 6586 IRIX6 linker. */ 6587 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION); 6588 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED; 6589 6590 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */ 6591 if (i == 0) 6592 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT; 6593 else 6594 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA; 6595 6596 break; 6597 } 6598 } 6599 6600 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various 6601 dynamic sections here. */ 6602 6603 bfd_boolean 6604 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd, 6605 struct bfd_link_info *info, 6606 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 6607 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym) 6608 { 6609 bfd *dynobj; 6610 bfd_vma gval; 6611 asection *sgot; 6612 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg; 6613 const char *name; 6614 6615 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 6616 gval = sym->st_value; 6617 6618 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1) 6619 { 6620 asection *s; 6621 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE]; 6622 6623 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */ 6624 6625 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1); 6626 6627 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, 6628 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)); 6629 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6630 6631 /* FIXME: Can h->dynindex be more than 64K? */ 6632 if (h->dynindx & 0xffff0000) 6633 return FALSE; 6634 6635 /* Fill the stub. */ 6636 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub); 6637 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + 4); 6638 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + 8); 6639 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16 (output_bfd) + h->dynindx, stub + 12); 6640 6641 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->_raw_size); 6642 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE); 6643 6644 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs 6645 only for the referenced symbol. */ 6646 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF; 6647 6648 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol 6649 to reset the global offset table entry for this external 6650 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */ 6651 gval = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset + h->plt.offset; 6652 sym->st_value = gval; 6653 } 6654 6655 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 6656 || (h->elf_link_hash_flags & ELF_LINK_FORCED_LOCAL) != 0); 6657 6658 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE); 6659 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL); 6660 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL); 6661 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info; 6662 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 6663 6664 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all 6665 the symbols that need them. */ 6666 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL 6667 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx) 6668 { 6669 bfd_vma offset; 6670 bfd_vma value; 6671 6672 value = sym->st_value; 6673 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h); 6674 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset); 6675 } 6676 6677 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1) 6678 { 6679 struct mips_got_entry e, *p; 6680 bfd_vma entry; 6681 bfd_vma offset; 6682 6683 gg = g; 6684 6685 e.abfd = output_bfd; 6686 e.symndx = -1; 6687 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h; 6688 6689 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next) 6690 { 6691 if (g->got_entries 6692 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries, 6693 &e))) 6694 { 6695 offset = p->gotidx; 6696 if (info->shared 6697 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created 6698 && p->d.h != NULL 6699 && ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 6700 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_DYNAMIC) != 0) 6701 && ((p->d.h->root.elf_link_hash_flags 6702 & ELF_LINK_HASH_DEF_REGULAR) == 0))) 6703 { 6704 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to 6705 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock 6706 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave 6707 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the 6708 appropriate addend. */ 6709 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3]; 6710 6711 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel)); 6712 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)) 6713 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64); 6714 else 6715 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32); 6716 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset; 6717 6718 entry = 0; 6719 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation 6720 (output_bfd, info, rel, 6721 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot))) 6722 return FALSE; 6723 } 6724 else 6725 entry = sym->st_value; 6726 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset); 6727 } 6728 } 6729 } 6730 6731 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */ 6732 name = h->root.root.string; 6733 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0 6734 || strcmp (name, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0) 6735 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS; 6736 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0 6737 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0) 6738 { 6739 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS; 6740 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION); 6741 sym->st_value = 1; 6742 } 6743 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)) 6744 { 6745 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS; 6746 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION); 6747 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd); 6748 } 6749 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 6750 { 6751 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0 6752 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0) 6753 { 6754 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION); 6755 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED; 6756 sym->st_value = 0; 6757 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA; 6758 } 6759 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0) 6760 { 6761 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION); 6762 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED; 6763 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count; 6764 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS; 6765 } 6766 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS) 6767 { 6768 if (h->type == STT_FUNC) 6769 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT; 6770 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT) 6771 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA; 6772 } 6773 } 6774 6775 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */ 6776 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6) 6777 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym); 6778 6779 if (! info->shared) 6780 { 6781 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head 6782 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0 6783 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0)) 6784 { 6785 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map"); 6786 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6787 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset; 6788 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents); 6789 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0) 6790 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value; 6791 } 6792 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head 6793 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0) 6794 { 6795 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */ 6796 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5 6797 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none) 6798 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map") 6799 != NULL); 6800 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value; 6801 } 6802 } 6803 6804 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */ 6805 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16 6806 && (sym->st_value & 1) != 0) 6807 --sym->st_value; 6808 6809 return TRUE; 6810 } 6811 6812 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */ 6813 6814 bfd_boolean 6815 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd, 6816 struct bfd_link_info *info) 6817 { 6818 bfd *dynobj; 6819 asection *sdyn; 6820 asection *sgot; 6821 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g; 6822 6823 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 6824 6825 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic"); 6826 6827 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE); 6828 if (sgot == NULL) 6829 gg = g = NULL; 6830 else 6831 { 6832 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL); 6833 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info; 6834 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL); 6835 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd); 6836 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 6837 } 6838 6839 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 6840 { 6841 bfd_byte *b; 6842 6843 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL); 6844 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL); 6845 6846 for (b = sdyn->contents; 6847 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->_raw_size; 6848 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj)) 6849 { 6850 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn; 6851 const char *name; 6852 size_t elemsize; 6853 asection *s; 6854 bfd_boolean swap_out_p; 6855 6856 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */ 6857 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn); 6858 6859 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */ 6860 swap_out_p = TRUE; 6861 6862 switch (dyn.d_tag) 6863 { 6864 case DT_RELENT: 6865 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE); 6866 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6867 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj); 6868 break; 6869 6870 case DT_STRSZ: 6871 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */ 6872 dyn.d_un.d_val = 6873 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr); 6874 break; 6875 6876 case DT_PLTGOT: 6877 name = ".got"; 6878 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name); 6879 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6880 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma; 6881 break; 6882 6883 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION: 6884 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */ 6885 break; 6886 6887 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS: 6888 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */ 6889 break; 6890 6891 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP: 6892 time ((time_t *) &dyn.d_un.d_val); 6893 break; 6894 6895 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM: 6896 /* XXX FIXME: */ 6897 swap_out_p = FALSE; 6898 break; 6899 6900 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION: 6901 /* XXX FIXME: */ 6902 swap_out_p = FALSE; 6903 break; 6904 6905 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS: 6906 s = output_bfd->sections; 6907 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6908 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff; 6909 break; 6910 6911 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO: 6912 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno; 6913 break; 6914 6915 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO: 6916 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the 6917 entry of the first external symbol that is not 6918 referenced within the same object. */ 6919 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1; 6920 break; 6921 6922 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM: 6923 if (gg->global_gotsym) 6924 { 6925 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx; 6926 break; 6927 } 6928 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default 6929 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as 6930 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */ 6931 6932 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO: 6933 name = ".dynsym"; 6934 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd); 6935 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name); 6936 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL); 6937 6938 if (s->_cooked_size != 0) 6939 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_cooked_size / elemsize; 6940 else 6941 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->_raw_size / elemsize; 6942 break; 6943 6944 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO: 6945 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO; 6946 break; 6947 6948 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP: 6949 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value; 6950 break; 6951 6952 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS: 6953 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name 6954 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd))); 6955 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma; 6956 break; 6957 6958 case DT_RELSZ: 6959 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we 6960 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld, 6961 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there 6962 are trailing null entries. */ 6963 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 6964 { 6965 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE); 6966 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count 6967 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd) 6968 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel) 6969 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel))); 6970 } 6971 else 6972 swap_out_p = FALSE; 6973 break; 6974 6975 default: 6976 swap_out_p = FALSE; 6977 break; 6978 } 6979 6980 if (swap_out_p) 6981 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out) 6982 (dynobj, &dyn, b); 6983 } 6984 } 6985 6986 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at 6987 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders. 6988 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */ 6989 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->_raw_size > 0) 6990 { 6991 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents); 6992 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, 6993 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd)); 6994 } 6995 6996 if (sgot != NULL) 6997 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize 6998 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd); 6999 7000 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */ 7001 if (gg != NULL && gg->next) 7002 { 7003 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3]; 7004 bfd_vma addend = 0; 7005 7006 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel)); 7007 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32); 7008 7009 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next) 7010 { 7011 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno; 7012 7013 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents 7014 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd)); 7015 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents 7016 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd)); 7017 7018 if (! info->shared) 7019 continue; 7020 7021 while (index < g->assigned_gotno) 7022 { 7023 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset 7024 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd); 7025 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation 7026 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL, 7027 bfd_abs_section_ptr, 7028 0, &addend, sgot))) 7029 return FALSE; 7030 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0); 7031 } 7032 } 7033 } 7034 7035 { 7036 asection *s; 7037 Elf32_compact_rel cpt; 7038 7039 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)) 7040 { 7041 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */ 7042 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel"); 7043 if (s != NULL) 7044 { 7045 cpt.id1 = 1; 7046 cpt.num = s->reloc_count; 7047 cpt.id2 = 2; 7048 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos 7049 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel)); 7050 cpt.reserved0 = 0; 7051 cpt.reserved1 = 0; 7052 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt, 7053 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *) 7054 s->contents)); 7055 7056 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */ 7057 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, 7058 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)); 7059 if (s != NULL) 7060 { 7061 file_ptr dummy_offset; 7062 7063 BFD_ASSERT (s->_raw_size >= MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE); 7064 dummy_offset = s->_raw_size - MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE; 7065 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0, 7066 MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE); 7067 } 7068 } 7069 } 7070 7071 /* We need to sort the entries of the dynamic relocation section. */ 7072 7073 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE); 7074 7075 if (s != NULL 7076 && s->_raw_size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)) 7077 { 7078 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd; 7079 7080 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)) 7081 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1, 7082 sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs_64); 7083 else 7084 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1, 7085 sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs); 7086 } 7087 } 7088 7089 return TRUE; 7090 } 7091 7092 7093 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */ 7094 7095 static void 7096 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd) 7097 { 7098 flagword val; 7099 7100 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd)) 7101 { 7102 default: 7103 case bfd_mach_mips3000: 7104 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1; 7105 break; 7106 7107 case bfd_mach_mips3900: 7108 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900; 7109 break; 7110 7111 case bfd_mach_mips6000: 7112 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2; 7113 break; 7114 7115 case bfd_mach_mips4000: 7116 case bfd_mach_mips4300: 7117 case bfd_mach_mips4400: 7118 case bfd_mach_mips4600: 7119 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3; 7120 break; 7121 7122 case bfd_mach_mips4010: 7123 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010; 7124 break; 7125 7126 case bfd_mach_mips4100: 7127 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100; 7128 break; 7129 7130 case bfd_mach_mips4111: 7131 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111; 7132 break; 7133 7134 case bfd_mach_mips4120: 7135 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120; 7136 break; 7137 7138 case bfd_mach_mips4650: 7139 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650; 7140 break; 7141 7142 case bfd_mach_mips5400: 7143 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400; 7144 break; 7145 7146 case bfd_mach_mips5500: 7147 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500; 7148 break; 7149 7150 case bfd_mach_mips5000: 7151 case bfd_mach_mips7000: 7152 case bfd_mach_mips8000: 7153 case bfd_mach_mips10000: 7154 case bfd_mach_mips12000: 7155 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4; 7156 break; 7157 7158 case bfd_mach_mips5: 7159 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5; 7160 break; 7161 7162 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1: 7163 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1; 7164 break; 7165 7166 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32: 7167 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32; 7168 break; 7169 7170 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64: 7171 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64; 7172 break; 7173 7174 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2: 7175 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2; 7176 break; 7177 7178 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2: 7179 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2; 7180 break; 7181 } 7182 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH); 7183 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val; 7184 7185 } 7186 7187 7188 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object 7189 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine 7190 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */ 7191 7192 void 7193 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, 7194 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 7195 { 7196 unsigned int i; 7197 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp; 7198 const char *name; 7199 asection *sec; 7200 7201 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former 7202 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used 7203 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */ 7204 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0) 7205 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd); 7206 7207 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate 7208 info for each special section. */ 7209 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1; 7210 i < elf_numsections (abfd); 7211 i++, hdrpp++) 7212 { 7213 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type) 7214 { 7215 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM: 7216 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST: 7217 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr"); 7218 if (sec != NULL) 7219 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7220 break; 7221 7222 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB: 7223 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL); 7224 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section); 7225 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL 7226 && strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0); 7227 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1); 7228 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL); 7229 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7230 break; 7231 7232 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT: 7233 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL); 7234 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section); 7235 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL 7236 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", 7237 sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) == 0); 7238 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, 7239 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1); 7240 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL); 7241 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7242 break; 7243 7244 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB: 7245 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym"); 7246 if (sec != NULL) 7247 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7248 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist"); 7249 if (sec != NULL) 7250 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7251 break; 7252 7253 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS: 7254 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL); 7255 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section); 7256 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL); 7257 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0) 7258 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, 7259 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1); 7260 else 7261 { 7262 BFD_ASSERT (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel", 7263 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0); 7264 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, 7265 (name 7266 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1)); 7267 } 7268 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL); 7269 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx; 7270 break; 7271 7272 } 7273 } 7274 } 7275 7276 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC 7277 segments. */ 7278 7279 int 7280 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd) 7281 { 7282 asection *s; 7283 int ret = 0; 7284 7285 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */ 7286 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo"); 7287 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD)) 7288 ++ret; 7289 7290 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */ 7291 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6 7292 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, 7293 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd))) 7294 ++ret; 7295 7296 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */ 7297 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 7298 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") 7299 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug")) 7300 ++ret; 7301 7302 return ret; 7303 } 7304 7305 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */ 7306 7307 bfd_boolean 7308 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd, 7309 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 7310 { 7311 asection *s; 7312 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm; 7313 bfd_size_type amt; 7314 7315 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO 7316 segment. */ 7317 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo"); 7318 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) 7319 { 7320 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next) 7321 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO) 7322 break; 7323 if (m == NULL) 7324 { 7325 amt = sizeof *m; 7326 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7327 if (m == NULL) 7328 return FALSE; 7329 7330 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO; 7331 m->count = 1; 7332 m->sections[0] = s; 7333 7334 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */ 7335 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; 7336 while (*pm != NULL 7337 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR 7338 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP)) 7339 pm = &(*pm)->next; 7340 7341 m->next = *pm; 7342 *pm = m; 7343 } 7344 } 7345 7346 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but 7347 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a 7348 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header 7349 table. */ 7350 if (NEWABI_P (abfd) 7351 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment 7352 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this 7353 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right 7354 now. */ 7355 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6) 7356 { 7357 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next) 7358 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS) 7359 break; 7360 7361 if (s) 7362 { 7363 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment; 7364 7365 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; 7366 while (*pm != NULL 7367 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR 7368 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP)) 7369 pm = &(*pm)->next; 7370 7371 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map); 7372 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7373 options_segment->next = *pm; 7374 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS; 7375 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R; 7376 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE; 7377 options_segment->count = 1; 7378 options_segment->sections[0] = s; 7379 *pm = options_segment; 7380 } 7381 } 7382 else 7383 { 7384 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5) 7385 { 7386 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room 7387 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */ 7388 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL 7389 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL 7390 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL) 7391 { 7392 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next) 7393 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC) 7394 break; 7395 if (m == NULL) 7396 { 7397 amt = sizeof *m; 7398 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7399 if (m == NULL) 7400 return FALSE; 7401 7402 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC; 7403 7404 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc"); 7405 if (s == NULL) 7406 { 7407 m->count = 0; 7408 m->p_flags = 0; 7409 m->p_flags_valid = 1; 7410 } 7411 else 7412 { 7413 m->count = 1; 7414 m->sections[0] = s; 7415 } 7416 7417 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */ 7418 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; 7419 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC) 7420 pm = &(*pm)->next; 7421 if (*pm != NULL) 7422 pm = &(*pm)->next; 7423 7424 m->next = *pm; 7425 *pm = m; 7426 } 7427 } 7428 } 7429 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic, 7430 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in 7431 between. */ 7432 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; 7433 pm = &(*pm)->next) 7434 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC) 7435 break; 7436 m = *pm; 7437 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none) 7438 { 7439 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC 7440 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since 7441 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters 7442 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */ 7443 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL) 7444 { 7445 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X; 7446 m->p_flags_valid = 1; 7447 } 7448 } 7449 if (m != NULL 7450 && m->count == 1 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0) 7451 { 7452 static const char *sec_names[] = 7453 { 7454 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash" 7455 }; 7456 bfd_vma low, high; 7457 unsigned int i, c; 7458 struct elf_segment_map *n; 7459 7460 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0; 7461 high = 0; 7462 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++) 7463 { 7464 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]); 7465 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0) 7466 { 7467 bfd_size_type sz; 7468 7469 if (low > s->vma) 7470 low = s->vma; 7471 sz = s->_cooked_size; 7472 if (sz == 0) 7473 sz = s->_raw_size; 7474 if (high < s->vma + sz) 7475 high = s->vma + sz; 7476 } 7477 } 7478 7479 c = 0; 7480 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 7481 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 7482 && s->vma >= low 7483 && ((s->vma 7484 + (s->_cooked_size != 7485 0 ? s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high)) 7486 ++c; 7487 7488 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *); 7489 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7490 if (n == NULL) 7491 return FALSE; 7492 *n = *m; 7493 n->count = c; 7494 7495 i = 0; 7496 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next) 7497 { 7498 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 7499 && s->vma >= low 7500 && ((s->vma 7501 + (s->_cooked_size != 0 ? 7502 s->_cooked_size : s->_raw_size)) <= high)) 7503 { 7504 n->sections[i] = s; 7505 ++i; 7506 } 7507 } 7508 7509 *pm = n; 7510 } 7511 } 7512 7513 return TRUE; 7514 } 7515 7516 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given 7517 relocation. */ 7518 7519 asection * 7520 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec, 7521 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 7522 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, 7523 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, 7524 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym) 7525 { 7526 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */ 7527 7528 if (h != NULL) 7529 { 7530 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info)) 7531 { 7532 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT: 7533 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY: 7534 break; 7535 7536 default: 7537 switch (h->root.type) 7538 { 7539 case bfd_link_hash_defined: 7540 case bfd_link_hash_defweak: 7541 return h->root.u.def.section; 7542 7543 case bfd_link_hash_common: 7544 return h->root.u.c.p->section; 7545 7546 default: 7547 break; 7548 } 7549 } 7550 } 7551 else 7552 return bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx); 7553 7554 return NULL; 7555 } 7556 7557 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */ 7558 7559 bfd_boolean 7560 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 7561 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 7562 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, 7563 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) 7564 { 7565 #if 0 7566 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr; 7567 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes; 7568 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts; 7569 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend; 7570 unsigned long r_symndx; 7571 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h; 7572 7573 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr; 7574 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd); 7575 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd); 7576 7577 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count; 7578 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++) 7579 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info)) 7580 { 7581 case R_MIPS_GOT16: 7582 case R_MIPS_CALL16: 7583 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16: 7584 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16: 7585 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16: 7586 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16: 7587 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP: 7588 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE: 7589 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST: 7590 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort 7591 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries, 7592 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */ 7593 break; 7594 7595 default: 7596 break; 7597 } 7598 #endif 7599 7600 return TRUE; 7601 } 7602 7603 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol, 7604 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation 7605 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let 7606 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */ 7607 7608 void 7609 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (const struct elf_backend_data *bed, 7610 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir, 7611 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind) 7612 { 7613 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips; 7614 7615 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (bed, dir, ind); 7616 7617 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect) 7618 return; 7619 7620 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir; 7621 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind; 7622 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs; 7623 if (indmips->readonly_reloc) 7624 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE; 7625 if (indmips->no_fn_stub) 7626 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE; 7627 } 7628 7629 void 7630 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, 7631 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry, 7632 bfd_boolean force_local) 7633 { 7634 bfd *dynobj; 7635 asection *got; 7636 struct mips_got_info *g; 7637 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 7638 7639 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry; 7640 if (h->forced_local) 7641 return; 7642 h->forced_local = force_local; 7643 7644 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 7645 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS 7646 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE)) != NULL 7647 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL) 7648 { 7649 if (g->next) 7650 { 7651 struct mips_got_entry e; 7652 struct mips_got_info *gg = g; 7653 7654 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a 7655 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT 7656 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease 7657 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually 7658 the upper limit of global entries. */ 7659 e.abfd = dynobj; 7660 e.symndx = -1; 7661 e.d.h = h; 7662 7663 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next) 7664 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e)) 7665 { 7666 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0); 7667 g->local_gotno++; 7668 g->global_gotno--; 7669 } 7670 7671 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we 7672 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry 7673 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one 7674 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */ 7675 if (h->root.got.offset == 2) 7676 { 7677 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0); 7678 gg->assigned_gotno--; 7679 } 7680 } 7681 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL) 7682 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the 7683 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as 7684 global. */ 7685 g->local_gotno++; 7686 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1) 7687 { 7688 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had 7689 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry 7690 instead. */ 7691 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0); 7692 g->local_gotno++; 7693 g->global_gotno--; 7694 } 7695 } 7696 7697 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local); 7698 } 7699 7700 #define PDR_SIZE 32 7701 7702 bfd_boolean 7703 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie, 7704 struct bfd_link_info *info) 7705 { 7706 asection *o; 7707 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE; 7708 unsigned char *tdata; 7709 size_t i, skip; 7710 7711 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr"); 7712 if (! o) 7713 return FALSE; 7714 if (o->_raw_size == 0) 7715 return FALSE; 7716 if (o->_raw_size % PDR_SIZE != 0) 7717 return FALSE; 7718 if (o->output_section != NULL 7719 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section)) 7720 return FALSE; 7721 7722 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE); 7723 if (! tdata) 7724 return FALSE; 7725 7726 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL, 7727 info->keep_memory); 7728 if (!cookie->rels) 7729 { 7730 free (tdata); 7731 return FALSE; 7732 } 7733 7734 cookie->rel = cookie->rels; 7735 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count; 7736 7737 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->_raw_size / PDR_SIZE; i ++) 7738 { 7739 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie)) 7740 { 7741 tdata[i] = 1; 7742 skip ++; 7743 } 7744 } 7745 7746 if (skip != 0) 7747 { 7748 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata; 7749 o->_cooked_size = o->_raw_size - skip * PDR_SIZE; 7750 ret = TRUE; 7751 } 7752 else 7753 free (tdata); 7754 7755 if (! info->keep_memory) 7756 free (cookie->rels); 7757 7758 return ret; 7759 } 7760 7761 bfd_boolean 7762 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec) 7763 { 7764 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0) 7765 return TRUE; 7766 return FALSE; 7767 } 7768 7769 bfd_boolean 7770 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd, asection *sec, 7771 bfd_byte *contents) 7772 { 7773 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end; 7774 int i; 7775 7776 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0) 7777 return FALSE; 7778 7779 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL) 7780 return FALSE; 7781 7782 to = contents; 7783 end = contents + sec->_raw_size; 7784 for (from = contents, i = 0; 7785 from < end; 7786 from += PDR_SIZE, i++) 7787 { 7788 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1) 7789 continue; 7790 if (to != from) 7791 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE); 7792 to += PDR_SIZE; 7793 } 7794 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents, 7795 sec->output_offset, sec->_cooked_size); 7796 return TRUE; 7797 } 7798 7799 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the 7800 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */ 7801 7802 struct mips_elf_find_line 7803 { 7804 struct ecoff_debug_info d; 7805 struct ecoff_find_line i; 7806 }; 7807 7808 bfd_boolean 7809 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section, 7810 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset, 7811 const char **filename_ptr, 7812 const char **functionname_ptr, 7813 unsigned int *line_ptr) 7814 { 7815 asection *msec; 7816 7817 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset, 7818 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, 7819 line_ptr)) 7820 return TRUE; 7821 7822 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset, 7823 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, 7824 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0, 7825 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)) 7826 return TRUE; 7827 7828 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"); 7829 if (msec != NULL) 7830 { 7831 flagword origflags; 7832 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi; 7833 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap = 7834 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap; 7835 7836 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have 7837 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here 7838 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */ 7839 origflags = msec->flags; 7840 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS) 7841 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 7842 7843 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info; 7844 if (fi == NULL) 7845 { 7846 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size; 7847 char *fraw_src; 7848 char *fraw_end; 7849 struct fdr *fdr_ptr; 7850 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line); 7851 7852 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7853 if (fi == NULL) 7854 { 7855 msec->flags = origflags; 7856 return FALSE; 7857 } 7858 7859 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d)) 7860 { 7861 msec->flags = origflags; 7862 return FALSE; 7863 } 7864 7865 /* Swap in the FDR information. */ 7866 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr); 7867 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt); 7868 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL) 7869 { 7870 msec->flags = origflags; 7871 return FALSE; 7872 } 7873 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size; 7874 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr; 7875 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr; 7876 fraw_end = (fraw_src 7877 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size); 7878 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++) 7879 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr); 7880 7881 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi; 7882 7883 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information. 7884 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in 7885 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is 7886 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory 7887 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a 7888 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */ 7889 } 7890 7891 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap, 7892 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, 7893 line_ptr)) 7894 { 7895 msec->flags = origflags; 7896 return TRUE; 7897 } 7898 7899 msec->flags = origflags; 7900 } 7901 7902 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */ 7903 7904 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset, 7905 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, 7906 line_ptr); 7907 } 7908 7909 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section, 7910 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the 7911 GP value in the section_processing routine. */ 7912 7913 bfd_boolean 7914 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section, 7915 const void *location, 7916 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count) 7917 { 7918 if (strcmp (section->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0) 7919 { 7920 bfd_byte *c; 7921 7922 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL) 7923 { 7924 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data); 7925 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt); 7926 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL) 7927 return FALSE; 7928 } 7929 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata; 7930 if (c == NULL) 7931 { 7932 bfd_size_type size; 7933 7934 if (section->_cooked_size != 0) 7935 size = section->_cooked_size; 7936 else 7937 size = section->_raw_size; 7938 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size); 7939 if (c == NULL) 7940 return FALSE; 7941 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c; 7942 } 7943 7944 memcpy (c + offset, location, count); 7945 } 7946 7947 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset, 7948 count); 7949 } 7950 7951 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some 7952 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */ 7953 7954 bfd_byte * 7955 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents 7956 (bfd *abfd, 7957 struct bfd_link_info *link_info, 7958 struct bfd_link_order *link_order, 7959 bfd_byte *data, 7960 bfd_boolean relocatable, 7961 asymbol **symbols) 7962 { 7963 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */ 7964 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner; 7965 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section; 7966 7967 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section); 7968 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL; 7969 long reloc_count; 7970 7971 if (reloc_size < 0) 7972 goto error_return; 7973 7974 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size); 7975 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0) 7976 goto error_return; 7977 7978 /* read in the section */ 7979 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, 7980 input_section->_raw_size)) 7981 goto error_return; 7982 7983 /* We're not relaxing the section, so just copy the size info */ 7984 input_section->_cooked_size = input_section->_raw_size; 7985 input_section->reloc_done = TRUE; 7986 7987 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd, 7988 input_section, 7989 reloc_vector, 7990 symbols); 7991 if (reloc_count < 0) 7992 goto error_return; 7993 7994 if (reloc_count > 0) 7995 { 7996 arelent **parent; 7997 /* for mips */ 7998 int gp_found; 7999 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */ 8000 8001 { 8002 struct bfd_hash_entry *h; 8003 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh; 8004 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */ 8005 if (abfd && input_bfd 8006 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec) 8007 lh = 0; 8008 else 8009 { 8010 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE); 8011 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h; 8012 } 8013 lookup: 8014 if (lh) 8015 { 8016 switch (lh->type) 8017 { 8018 case bfd_link_hash_undefined: 8019 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak: 8020 case bfd_link_hash_common: 8021 gp_found = 0; 8022 break; 8023 case bfd_link_hash_defined: 8024 case bfd_link_hash_defweak: 8025 gp_found = 1; 8026 gp = lh->u.def.value; 8027 break; 8028 case bfd_link_hash_indirect: 8029 case bfd_link_hash_warning: 8030 lh = lh->u.i.link; 8031 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */ 8032 goto lookup; 8033 case bfd_link_hash_new: 8034 default: 8035 abort (); 8036 } 8037 } 8038 else 8039 gp_found = 0; 8040 } 8041 /* end mips */ 8042 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++) 8043 { 8044 char *error_message = NULL; 8045 bfd_reloc_status_type r; 8046 8047 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require 8048 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */ 8049 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr; 8050 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section) && abfd) 8051 { 8052 /* The special_function wouldn't get called anyway. */ 8053 } 8054 else if (!gp_found) 8055 { 8056 /* The gp isn't there; let the special function code 8057 fall over on its own. */ 8058 } 8059 else if ((*parent)->howto->special_function 8060 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc) 8061 { 8062 /* bypass special_function call */ 8063 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent, 8064 input_section, relocatable, 8065 data, gp); 8066 goto skip_bfd_perform_relocation; 8067 } 8068 /* end mips specific stuff */ 8069 8070 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data, input_section, 8071 relocatable ? abfd : NULL, 8072 &error_message); 8073 skip_bfd_perform_relocation: 8074 8075 if (relocatable) 8076 { 8077 asection *os = input_section->output_section; 8078 8079 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */ 8080 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent; 8081 os->reloc_count++; 8082 } 8083 8084 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok) 8085 { 8086 switch (r) 8087 { 8088 case bfd_reloc_undefined: 8089 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) 8090 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr), 8091 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, 8092 TRUE))) 8093 goto error_return; 8094 break; 8095 case bfd_reloc_dangerous: 8096 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL); 8097 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous) 8098 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section, 8099 (*parent)->address))) 8100 goto error_return; 8101 break; 8102 case bfd_reloc_overflow: 8103 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow) 8104 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr), 8105 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend, 8106 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address))) 8107 goto error_return; 8108 break; 8109 case bfd_reloc_outofrange: 8110 default: 8111 abort (); 8112 break; 8113 } 8114 8115 } 8116 } 8117 } 8118 if (reloc_vector != NULL) 8119 free (reloc_vector); 8120 return data; 8121 8122 error_return: 8123 if (reloc_vector != NULL) 8124 free (reloc_vector); 8125 return NULL; 8126 } 8127 8128 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */ 8129 8130 struct bfd_link_hash_table * 8131 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd) 8132 { 8133 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret; 8134 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table); 8135 8136 ret = bfd_malloc (amt); 8137 if (ret == NULL) 8138 return NULL; 8139 8140 if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd, 8141 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc)) 8142 { 8143 free (ret); 8144 return NULL; 8145 } 8146 8147 #if 0 8148 /* We no longer use this. */ 8149 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++) 8150 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1; 8151 #endif 8152 ret->procedure_count = 0; 8153 ret->compact_rel_size = 0; 8154 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE; 8155 ret->rld_value = 0; 8156 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE; 8157 8158 return &ret->root.root; 8159 } 8160 8161 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and 8162 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these 8163 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */ 8164 8165 bfd_boolean 8166 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info) 8167 { 8168 asection **secpp; 8169 asection *o; 8170 struct bfd_link_order *p; 8171 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec; 8172 asection *rtproc_sec; 8173 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo; 8174 struct ecoff_debug_info debug; 8175 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap 8176 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap; 8177 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header; 8178 void *mdebug_handle = NULL; 8179 asection *s; 8180 EXTR esym; 8181 unsigned int i; 8182 bfd_size_type amt; 8183 8184 static const char * const secname[] = 8185 { 8186 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data", 8187 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss" 8188 }; 8189 static const int sc[] = 8190 { 8191 scText, scInit, scFini, scData, 8192 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss 8193 }; 8194 8195 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the 8196 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us. 8197 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do 8198 the sort again. */ 8199 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created) 8200 { 8201 bfd *dynobj; 8202 asection *got; 8203 struct mips_got_info *g; 8204 8205 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what 8206 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section 8207 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only 8208 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that 8209 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options 8210 section above. */ 8211 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, (info->shared 8212 ? bfd_count_sections (abfd) + 1 8213 : 1))) 8214 return FALSE; 8215 8216 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */ 8217 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj; 8218 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE); 8219 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info; 8220 8221 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL) 8222 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount 8223 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx) 8224 <= g->global_gotno); 8225 } 8226 8227 #if 0 8228 /* We want to set the GP value for ld -r. */ 8229 /* On IRIX5, we omit the .options section. On IRIX6, however, we 8230 include it, even though we don't process it quite right. (Some 8231 entries are supposed to be merged.) Empirically, we seem to be 8232 better off including it then not. */ 8233 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none) 8234 for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next) 8235 { 8236 if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == 0) 8237 { 8238 for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8239 if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order) 8240 p->u.indirect.section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8241 (*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL; 8242 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp); 8243 --abfd->section_count; 8244 8245 break; 8246 } 8247 } 8248 8249 /* We include .MIPS.options, even though we don't process it quite right. 8250 (Some entries are supposed to be merged.) At IRIX6 empirically we seem 8251 to be better off including it than not. */ 8252 for (secpp = &abfd->sections; *secpp != NULL; secpp = &(*secpp)->next) 8253 { 8254 if (strcmp ((*secpp)->name, ".MIPS.options") == 0) 8255 { 8256 for (p = (*secpp)->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8257 if (p->type == bfd_indirect_link_order) 8258 p->u.indirect.section->flags &=~ SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8259 (*secpp)->link_order_head = NULL; 8260 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp); 8261 --abfd->section_count; 8262 8263 break; 8264 } 8265 } 8266 #endif 8267 8268 /* Get a value for the GP register. */ 8269 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0) 8270 { 8271 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h; 8272 8273 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE); 8274 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined) 8275 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value 8276 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma 8277 + h->u.def.section->output_offset); 8278 else if (info->relocatable) 8279 { 8280 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE; 8281 8282 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */ 8283 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next) 8284 if (o->vma < lo 8285 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL)) 8286 lo = o->vma; 8287 8288 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */ 8289 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (abfd); 8290 } 8291 else 8292 { 8293 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc 8294 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous 8295 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */ 8296 } 8297 } 8298 8299 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug 8300 information. */ 8301 reginfo_sec = NULL; 8302 mdebug_sec = NULL; 8303 gptab_data_sec = NULL; 8304 gptab_bss_sec = NULL; 8305 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next) 8306 { 8307 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0) 8308 { 8309 memset (®info, 0, sizeof reginfo); 8310 8311 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file. 8312 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge 8313 the information together. */ 8314 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8315 { 8316 asection *input_section; 8317 bfd *input_bfd; 8318 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext; 8319 Elf32_RegInfo sub; 8320 8321 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order) 8322 { 8323 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order) 8324 continue; 8325 abort (); 8326 } 8327 8328 input_section = p->u.indirect.section; 8329 input_bfd = input_section->owner; 8330 8331 /* The linker emulation code has probably clobbered the 8332 size to be zero bytes. */ 8333 if (input_section->_raw_size == 0) 8334 input_section->_raw_size = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo); 8335 8336 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, 8337 &ext, 0, sizeof ext)) 8338 return FALSE; 8339 8340 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub); 8341 8342 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask; 8343 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0]; 8344 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1]; 8345 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2]; 8346 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3]; 8347 8348 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function 8349 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is 8350 finally written out. */ 8351 8352 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that 8353 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */ 8354 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8355 } 8356 8357 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */ 8358 BFD_ASSERT(o->_raw_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo)); 8359 8360 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently 8361 matters, but someday it might). */ 8362 o->link_order_head = NULL; 8363 8364 reginfo_sec = o; 8365 } 8366 8367 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0) 8368 { 8369 struct extsym_info einfo; 8370 bfd_vma last; 8371 8372 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file. 8373 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge 8374 the information together. */ 8375 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic; 8376 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */ 8377 symhdr->vstamp = 0; 8378 symhdr->ilineMax = 0; 8379 symhdr->cbLine = 0; 8380 symhdr->idnMax = 0; 8381 symhdr->ipdMax = 0; 8382 symhdr->isymMax = 0; 8383 symhdr->ioptMax = 0; 8384 symhdr->iauxMax = 0; 8385 symhdr->issMax = 0; 8386 symhdr->issExtMax = 0; 8387 symhdr->ifdMax = 0; 8388 symhdr->crfd = 0; 8389 symhdr->iextMax = 0; 8390 8391 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the 8392 debug_info structure. */ 8393 debug.line = NULL; 8394 debug.external_dnr = NULL; 8395 debug.external_pdr = NULL; 8396 debug.external_sym = NULL; 8397 debug.external_opt = NULL; 8398 debug.external_aux = NULL; 8399 debug.ss = NULL; 8400 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL; 8401 debug.external_fdr = NULL; 8402 debug.external_rfd = NULL; 8403 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL; 8404 8405 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info); 8406 if (mdebug_handle == NULL) 8407 return FALSE; 8408 8409 esym.jmptbl = 0; 8410 esym.cobol_main = 0; 8411 esym.weakext = 0; 8412 esym.reserved = 0; 8413 esym.ifd = ifdNil; 8414 esym.asym.iss = issNil; 8415 esym.asym.st = stLocal; 8416 esym.asym.reserved = 0; 8417 esym.asym.index = indexNil; 8418 last = 0; 8419 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++) 8420 { 8421 esym.asym.sc = sc[i]; 8422 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]); 8423 if (s != NULL) 8424 { 8425 esym.asym.value = s->vma; 8426 last = s->vma + s->_raw_size; 8427 } 8428 else 8429 esym.asym.value = last; 8430 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap, 8431 secname[i], &esym)) 8432 return FALSE; 8433 } 8434 8435 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8436 { 8437 asection *input_section; 8438 bfd *input_bfd; 8439 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap; 8440 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug; 8441 char *eraw_src; 8442 char *eraw_end; 8443 8444 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order) 8445 { 8446 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order) 8447 continue; 8448 abort (); 8449 } 8450 8451 input_section = p->u.indirect.section; 8452 input_bfd = input_section->owner; 8453 8454 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour 8455 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd) 8456 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL) 8457 { 8458 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be 8459 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really 8460 want to deal with it. */ 8461 continue; 8462 } 8463 8464 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd) 8465 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap); 8466 8467 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->_raw_size); 8468 8469 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already 8470 read in the debugging information and set up an 8471 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */ 8472 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section, 8473 &input_debug)) 8474 return FALSE; 8475 8476 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate 8477 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd, 8478 &input_debug, input_swap, info))) 8479 return FALSE; 8480 8481 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with 8482 interesting information, try to find the symbol in 8483 the linker global hash table and save the information 8484 for the output external symbols. */ 8485 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext; 8486 eraw_end = (eraw_src 8487 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax 8488 * input_swap->external_ext_size)); 8489 for (; 8490 eraw_src < eraw_end; 8491 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size) 8492 { 8493 EXTR ext; 8494 const char *name; 8495 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h; 8496 8497 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext); 8498 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil 8499 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined 8500 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined) 8501 continue; 8502 8503 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss; 8504 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info), 8505 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE); 8506 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2) 8507 continue; 8508 8509 if (ext.ifd != -1) 8510 { 8511 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd 8512 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax); 8513 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd]; 8514 } 8515 8516 h->esym = ext; 8517 } 8518 8519 /* Free up the information we just read. */ 8520 free (input_debug.line); 8521 free (input_debug.external_dnr); 8522 free (input_debug.external_pdr); 8523 free (input_debug.external_sym); 8524 free (input_debug.external_opt); 8525 free (input_debug.external_aux); 8526 free (input_debug.ss); 8527 free (input_debug.ssext); 8528 free (input_debug.external_fdr); 8529 free (input_debug.external_rfd); 8530 free (input_debug.external_ext); 8531 8532 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that 8533 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */ 8534 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8535 } 8536 8537 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared) 8538 { 8539 /* Create .rtproc section. */ 8540 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc"); 8541 if (rtproc_sec == NULL) 8542 { 8543 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY 8544 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY); 8545 8546 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section (abfd, ".rtproc"); 8547 if (rtproc_sec == NULL 8548 || ! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, rtproc_sec, flags) 8549 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4)) 8550 return FALSE; 8551 } 8552 8553 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd, 8554 info, rtproc_sec, 8555 &debug)) 8556 return FALSE; 8557 } 8558 8559 /* Build the external symbol information. */ 8560 einfo.abfd = abfd; 8561 einfo.info = info; 8562 einfo.debug = &debug; 8563 einfo.swap = swap; 8564 einfo.failed = FALSE; 8565 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info), 8566 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo); 8567 if (einfo.failed) 8568 return FALSE; 8569 8570 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */ 8571 o->_raw_size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap); 8572 8573 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently 8574 matters, but someday it might). */ 8575 o->link_order_head = NULL; 8576 8577 mdebug_sec = o; 8578 } 8579 8580 if (strncmp (o->name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0) 8581 { 8582 const char *subname; 8583 unsigned int c; 8584 Elf32_gptab *tab; 8585 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab; 8586 unsigned int j; 8587 8588 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold 8589 information describing how the small data area would 8590 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections 8591 not used in executables files. */ 8592 if (! info->relocatable) 8593 { 8594 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8595 { 8596 asection *input_section; 8597 8598 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order) 8599 { 8600 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order) 8601 continue; 8602 abort (); 8603 } 8604 8605 input_section = p->u.indirect.section; 8606 8607 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that 8608 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */ 8609 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8610 } 8611 8612 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this 8613 currently matters, but someday it might). */ 8614 o->link_order_head = NULL; 8615 8616 /* Really remove the section. */ 8617 for (secpp = &abfd->sections; 8618 *secpp != o; 8619 secpp = &(*secpp)->next) 8620 ; 8621 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, secpp); 8622 --abfd->section_count; 8623 8624 continue; 8625 } 8626 8627 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for 8628 uninitialized data. */ 8629 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0) 8630 gptab_data_sec = o; 8631 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0) 8632 gptab_bss_sec = o; 8633 else 8634 { 8635 (*_bfd_error_handler) 8636 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"), 8637 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name); 8638 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section); 8639 return FALSE; 8640 } 8641 8642 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and 8643 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for 8644 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is 8645 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which 8646 case we must change the name of the output section. */ 8647 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1; 8648 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL) 8649 { 8650 if (o == gptab_data_sec) 8651 o->name = ".gptab.data"; 8652 else 8653 o->name = ".gptab.bss"; 8654 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1; 8655 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL); 8656 } 8657 8658 /* Set up the first entry. */ 8659 c = 1; 8660 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab); 8661 tab = bfd_malloc (amt); 8662 if (tab == NULL) 8663 return FALSE; 8664 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd); 8665 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0; 8666 8667 /* Combine the input sections. */ 8668 for (p = o->link_order_head; p != NULL; p = p->next) 8669 { 8670 asection *input_section; 8671 bfd *input_bfd; 8672 bfd_size_type size; 8673 unsigned long last; 8674 bfd_size_type gpentry; 8675 8676 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order) 8677 { 8678 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order) 8679 continue; 8680 abort (); 8681 } 8682 8683 input_section = p->u.indirect.section; 8684 input_bfd = input_section->owner; 8685 8686 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one 8687 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are 8688 sorted by ascending -G value. */ 8689 size = bfd_section_size (input_bfd, input_section); 8690 last = 0; 8691 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab); 8692 gpentry < size; 8693 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab)) 8694 { 8695 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab; 8696 Elf32_gptab int_gptab; 8697 unsigned long val; 8698 unsigned long add; 8699 bfd_boolean exact; 8700 unsigned int look; 8701 8702 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents 8703 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry, 8704 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab)))) 8705 { 8706 free (tab); 8707 return FALSE; 8708 } 8709 8710 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab, 8711 &int_gptab); 8712 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value; 8713 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last; 8714 8715 exact = FALSE; 8716 for (look = 1; look < c; look++) 8717 { 8718 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val) 8719 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add; 8720 8721 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val) 8722 exact = TRUE; 8723 } 8724 8725 if (! exact) 8726 { 8727 Elf32_gptab *new_tab; 8728 unsigned int max; 8729 8730 /* We need a new table entry. */ 8731 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab); 8732 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt); 8733 if (new_tab == NULL) 8734 { 8735 free (tab); 8736 return FALSE; 8737 } 8738 tab = new_tab; 8739 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val; 8740 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add; 8741 8742 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G 8743 value, since that will be implied by this new 8744 value. */ 8745 max = 0; 8746 for (look = 1; look < c; look++) 8747 { 8748 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val 8749 && (max == 0 8750 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value 8751 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value))) 8752 max = look; 8753 } 8754 if (max != 0) 8755 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes += 8756 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes; 8757 8758 ++c; 8759 } 8760 8761 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes; 8762 } 8763 8764 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that 8765 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */ 8766 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS; 8767 } 8768 8769 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */ 8770 if (c > 2) 8771 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare); 8772 8773 /* Swap out the table. */ 8774 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab); 8775 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt); 8776 if (ext_tab == NULL) 8777 { 8778 free (tab); 8779 return FALSE; 8780 } 8781 8782 for (j = 0; j < c; j++) 8783 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j); 8784 free (tab); 8785 8786 o->_raw_size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab); 8787 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab; 8788 8789 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently 8790 matters, but someday it might). */ 8791 o->link_order_head = NULL; 8792 } 8793 } 8794 8795 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */ 8796 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info)) 8797 return FALSE; 8798 8799 /* Now write out the computed sections. */ 8800 8801 if (reginfo_sec != NULL) 8802 { 8803 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext; 8804 8805 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, ®info, &ext); 8806 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext)) 8807 return FALSE; 8808 } 8809 8810 if (mdebug_sec != NULL) 8811 { 8812 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun); 8813 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, 8814 swap, info, 8815 mdebug_sec->filepos)) 8816 return FALSE; 8817 8818 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info); 8819 } 8820 8821 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL) 8822 { 8823 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec, 8824 gptab_data_sec->contents, 8825 0, gptab_data_sec->_raw_size)) 8826 return FALSE; 8827 } 8828 8829 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL) 8830 { 8831 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec, 8832 gptab_bss_sec->contents, 8833 0, gptab_bss_sec->_raw_size)) 8834 return FALSE; 8835 } 8836 8837 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)) 8838 { 8839 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc"); 8840 if (rtproc_sec != NULL) 8841 { 8842 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec, 8843 rtproc_sec->contents, 8844 0, rtproc_sec->_raw_size)) 8845 return FALSE; 8846 } 8847 } 8848 8849 return TRUE; 8850 } 8851 8852 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */ 8853 8854 struct mips_mach_extension { 8855 unsigned long extension, base; 8856 }; 8857 8858 8859 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries 8860 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */ 8861 8862 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = { 8863 /* MIPS64 extensions. */ 8864 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 }, 8865 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 }, 8866 8867 /* MIPS V extensions. */ 8868 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 }, 8869 8870 /* R10000 extensions. */ 8871 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 }, 8872 8873 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core 8874 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems 8875 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since 8876 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add 8877 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */ 8878 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 }, 8879 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 }, 8880 8881 /* MIPS IV extensions. */ 8882 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 }, 8883 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 }, 8884 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 }, 8885 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 }, 8886 8887 /* VR4100 extensions. */ 8888 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 }, 8889 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 }, 8890 8891 /* MIPS III extensions. */ 8892 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8893 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8894 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8895 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8896 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8897 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8898 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 }, 8899 8900 /* MIPS32 extensions. */ 8901 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 }, 8902 8903 /* MIPS II extensions. */ 8904 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 }, 8905 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 }, 8906 8907 /* MIPS I extensions. */ 8908 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 }, 8909 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 } 8910 }; 8911 8912 8913 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */ 8914 8915 static bfd_boolean 8916 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension) 8917 { 8918 size_t i; 8919 8920 for (i = 0; extension != base && i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++) 8921 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension) 8922 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base; 8923 8924 return extension == base; 8925 } 8926 8927 8928 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */ 8929 8930 static bfd_boolean 8931 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags) 8932 { 8933 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0 8934 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32 8935 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32 8936 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1 8937 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2 8938 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32 8939 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2); 8940 } 8941 8942 8943 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output 8944 object file when linking. */ 8945 8946 bfd_boolean 8947 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd) 8948 { 8949 flagword old_flags; 8950 flagword new_flags; 8951 bfd_boolean ok; 8952 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE; 8953 asection *sec; 8954 8955 /* Check if we have the same endianess */ 8956 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd)) 8957 { 8958 (*_bfd_error_handler) 8959 (_("%s: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"), 8960 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd)); 8961 return FALSE; 8962 } 8963 8964 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour 8965 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour) 8966 return TRUE; 8967 8968 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0) 8969 { 8970 (*_bfd_error_handler) 8971 (_("%s: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"), 8972 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd)); 8973 return FALSE; 8974 } 8975 8976 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags; 8977 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER; 8978 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags; 8979 8980 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd)) 8981 { 8982 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE; 8983 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags; 8984 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] 8985 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]; 8986 8987 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd) 8988 && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default) 8989 { 8990 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd), 8991 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))) 8992 return FALSE; 8993 } 8994 8995 return TRUE; 8996 } 8997 8998 /* Check flag compatibility. */ 8999 9000 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER; 9001 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER; 9002 9003 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It 9004 doesn't seem to matter. */ 9005 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT; 9006 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT; 9007 9008 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should 9009 just be able to ignore this. */ 9010 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE; 9011 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE; 9012 9013 if (new_flags == old_flags) 9014 return TRUE; 9015 9016 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections. 9017 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot 9018 actually cause any incompatibility. */ 9019 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next) 9020 { 9021 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections 9022 which are automatically generated by gas. */ 9023 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo") 9024 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug") 9025 && (sec->_raw_size != 0 9026 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text") 9027 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data") 9028 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss")))) 9029 { 9030 null_input_bfd = FALSE; 9031 break; 9032 } 9033 } 9034 if (null_input_bfd) 9035 return TRUE; 9036 9037 ok = TRUE; 9038 9039 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0) 9040 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)) 9041 { 9042 (*_bfd_error_handler) 9043 (_("%s: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"), 9044 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd)); 9045 ok = TRUE; 9046 } 9047 9048 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) 9049 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC; 9050 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)) 9051 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC; 9052 9053 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC); 9054 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC); 9055 9056 /* Compare the ISAs. */ 9057 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)) 9058 { 9059 (*_bfd_error_handler) 9060 (_("%s: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"), 9061 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd)); 9062 ok = FALSE; 9063 } 9064 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd))) 9065 { 9066 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */ 9067 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd))) 9068 { 9069 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy 9070 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise 9071 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */ 9072 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd)); 9073 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH); 9074 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags 9075 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE); 9076 9077 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them 9078 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */ 9079 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0 9080 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags) 9081 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI)) 9082 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI; 9083 } 9084 else 9085 { 9086 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */ 9087 (*_bfd_error_handler) 9088 (_("%s: linking %s module with previous %s modules"), 9089 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd), 9090 bfd_printable_name (ibfd), 9091 bfd_printable_name (obfd)); 9092 ok = FALSE; 9093 } 9094 } 9095 9096 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE); 9097 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE); 9098 9099 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it 9100 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */ 9101 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) 9102 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] 9103 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])) 9104 { 9105 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */ 9106 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)) 9107 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] 9108 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])) 9109 { 9110 (*_bfd_error_handler) 9111 (_("%s: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"), 9112 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd), 9113 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd), 9114 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd)); 9115 ok = FALSE; 9116 } 9117 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI; 9118 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI; 9119 } 9120 9121 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */ 9122 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE)) 9123 { 9124 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE; 9125 9126 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE; 9127 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE; 9128 } 9129 9130 /* Warn about any other mismatches */ 9131 if (new_flags != old_flags) 9132 { 9133 (*_bfd_error_handler) 9134 (_("%s: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"), 9135 bfd_archive_filename (ibfd), (unsigned long) new_flags, 9136 (unsigned long) old_flags); 9137 ok = FALSE; 9138 } 9139 9140 if (! ok) 9141 { 9142 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value); 9143 return FALSE; 9144 } 9145 9146 return TRUE; 9147 } 9148 9149 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */ 9150 9151 bfd_boolean 9152 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags) 9153 { 9154 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd) 9155 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags); 9156 9157 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags; 9158 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE; 9159 return TRUE; 9160 } 9161 9162 bfd_boolean 9163 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr) 9164 { 9165 FILE *file = ptr; 9166 9167 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL); 9168 9169 /* Print normal ELF private data. */ 9170 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr); 9171 9172 /* xgettext:c-format */ 9173 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags); 9174 9175 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32) 9176 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]")); 9177 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64) 9178 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]")); 9179 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32) 9180 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]")); 9181 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64) 9182 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]")); 9183 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)) 9184 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]")); 9185 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd)) 9186 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]")); 9187 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd)) 9188 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]")); 9189 else 9190 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]")); 9191 9192 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1) 9193 fprintf (file, _(" [mips1]")); 9194 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2) 9195 fprintf (file, _(" [mips2]")); 9196 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3) 9197 fprintf (file, _(" [mips3]")); 9198 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4) 9199 fprintf (file, _(" [mips4]")); 9200 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5) 9201 fprintf (file, _(" [mips5]")); 9202 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32) 9203 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32]")); 9204 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64) 9205 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64]")); 9206 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2) 9207 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32r2]")); 9208 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2) 9209 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64r2]")); 9210 else 9211 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]")); 9212 9213 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX) 9214 fprintf (file, _(" [mdmx]")); 9215 9216 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16) 9217 fprintf (file, _(" [mips16]")); 9218 9219 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) 9220 fprintf (file, _(" [32bitmode]")); 9221 else 9222 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]")); 9223 9224 fputc ('\n', file); 9225 9226 return TRUE; 9227 } 9228 9229 struct bfd_elf_special_section const _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[]= 9230 { 9231 { ".sdata", 6, -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL }, 9232 { ".sbss", 5, -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL }, 9233 { ".lit4", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL }, 9234 { ".lit8", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL }, 9235 { ".ucode", 6, 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 }, 9236 { ".mdebug", 7, 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 }, 9237 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 } 9238 }; 9239